blob: a39f12603ce23effc99bc7694a9430147a92f92d [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
39static Expr *
40CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation()) {
42 Expr *E = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc);
43 S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
44 return E;
45}
46
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000047static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
48 bool InOverloadResolution,
49 StandardConversionSequence &SCS);
50static OverloadingResult
51IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
52 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
53 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
54 bool AllowExplicit);
55
56
57static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
58CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
59 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
60 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
61
62static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
63CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
64 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
65 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
66
67static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
68CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
69 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
70 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
71
72
73
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000074/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
75/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000076ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000077GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
78 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
79 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
80 ICC_Identity,
81 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
82 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
83 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000084 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000085 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
86 ICC_Promotion,
87 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000088 ICC_Promotion,
89 ICC_Conversion,
90 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000091 ICC_Conversion,
92 ICC_Conversion,
93 ICC_Conversion,
94 ICC_Conversion,
95 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +000096 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +000097 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +000098 ICC_Conversion,
99 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Conversion
101 };
102 return Category[(int)Kind];
103}
104
105/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
106/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
107ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
108 static const ImplicitConversionRank
109 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
110 ICR_Exact_Match,
111 ICR_Exact_Match,
112 ICR_Exact_Match,
113 ICR_Exact_Match,
114 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000115 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000116 ICR_Promotion,
117 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000118 ICR_Promotion,
119 ICR_Conversion,
120 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000121 ICR_Conversion,
122 ICR_Conversion,
123 ICR_Conversion,
124 ICR_Conversion,
125 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000126 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000127 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000128 ICR_Conversion,
129 ICR_Conversion,
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +0000130 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000131 };
132 return Rank[(int)Kind];
133}
134
135/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
136/// implicit conversion.
137const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000138 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000139 "No conversion",
140 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
141 "Array-to-pointer",
142 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000143 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000144 "Qualification",
145 "Integral promotion",
146 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000147 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000148 "Integral conversion",
149 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000150 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000151 "Floating-integral conversion",
152 "Pointer conversion",
153 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000154 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000155 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000156 "Derived-to-base conversion",
157 "Vector conversion",
158 "Vector splat",
159 "Complex-real conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000160 };
161 return Name[Kind];
162}
163
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000164/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
165/// sequence to the identity conversion.
166void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
167 First = ICK_Identity;
168 Second = ICK_Identity;
169 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000170 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000171 ReferenceBinding = false;
172 DirectBinding = false;
Sebastian Redlf69a94a2009-03-29 22:46:24 +0000173 RRefBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000174 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000175}
176
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000177/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
178/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
179/// implicit conversions.
180ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
181 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
182 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
183 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
184 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
185 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
186 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
187 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
188 return Rank;
189}
190
191/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
192/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000193/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000194/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000195bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000196 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
197 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
198 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
199 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000200 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000201 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
202 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
203 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000204 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000205 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
206 return true;
207
208 return false;
209}
210
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000211/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
212/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
213/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
214/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000215bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000216StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000217isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000218 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000219 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000220
221 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
222 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
223 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
224 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
225 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
226
John McCall75851b12010-10-26 06:40:27 +0000227 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000228 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000229 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
230
231 return false;
232}
233
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000234/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
235/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
236void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000237 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238 bool PrintedSomething = false;
239 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000240 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000241 PrintedSomething = true;
242 }
243
244 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
245 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000246 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000247 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000248 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000249
250 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000251 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000252 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000253 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000254 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000255 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000256 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000257 PrintedSomething = true;
258 }
259
260 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
261 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000262 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000263 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000265 PrintedSomething = true;
266 }
267
268 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000269 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000270 }
271}
272
273/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
274/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
275void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000276 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000277 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
278 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000279 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000280 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000281 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000282 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000283 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000284 After.DebugPrint();
285 }
286}
287
288/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
289/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
290void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000291 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000292 switch (ConversionKind) {
293 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000294 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000295 Standard.DebugPrint();
296 break;
297 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000298 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000299 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
300 break;
301 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000302 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000303 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000304 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000305 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000306 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000307 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000308 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000309 break;
310 }
311
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000312 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000313}
314
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000315void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
316 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
317}
318
319void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
320 conversions().~ConversionSet();
321}
322
323void
324AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
325 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
326 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
327 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
328}
329
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000330namespace {
331 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
332 // template parameter and template argument information.
333 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
334 TemplateParameter Param;
335 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
336 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
337 };
338}
339
340/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
341/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
342OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000343static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
344 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000345 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000346 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
347 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
348 Result.Data = 0;
349 switch (TDK) {
350 case Sema::TDK_Success:
351 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000352 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
353 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000354 break;
355
356 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000357 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000358 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
359 break;
360
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000361 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000362 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000363 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
364 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000365 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
366 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
367 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
368 Result.Data = Saved;
369 break;
370 }
371
372 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000373 Result.Data = Info.take();
374 break;
375
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000376 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000377 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
378 break;
379 }
380
381 return Result;
382}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000383
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000384void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
385 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
386 case Sema::TDK_Success:
387 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
388 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000389 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
390 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000391 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000392 break;
393
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000394 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000395 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000396 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000397 Data = 0;
398 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000399
400 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
401 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
402 Data = 0;
403 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000404
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000405 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000406 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000407 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
408 break;
409 }
410}
411
412TemplateParameter
413OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
414 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
415 case Sema::TDK_Success:
416 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000417 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
418 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000419 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000420 return TemplateParameter();
421
422 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000423 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000424 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
425
426 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000427 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000428 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
429
430 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000431 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000432 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
433 break;
434 }
435
436 return TemplateParameter();
437}
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000438
439TemplateArgumentList *
440OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
441 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
442 case Sema::TDK_Success:
443 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
444 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
445 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
446 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
447 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
448 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000449 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000450 return 0;
451
452 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
453 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
454
455 // Unhandled
456 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
457 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
458 break;
459 }
460
461 return 0;
462}
463
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000464const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
465 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
466 case Sema::TDK_Success:
467 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
468 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000469 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
470 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000471 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000472 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000473 return 0;
474
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000475 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000476 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000477 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
478
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000479 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000480 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000481 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
482 break;
483 }
484
485 return 0;
486}
487
488const TemplateArgument *
489OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
490 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
491 case Sema::TDK_Success:
492 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
493 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000494 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
495 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000497 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000498 return 0;
499
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000500 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000501 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000502 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
503
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000504 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000505 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000506 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
507 break;
508 }
509
510 return 0;
511}
512
513void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000514 inherited::clear();
515 Functions.clear();
516}
517
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000518// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000519// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
520// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
521// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
522// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000523// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
524// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
525// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000526//
527// Example: Given the following input:
528//
529// void f(int, float); // #1
530// void f(int, int); // #2
531// int f(int, int); // #3
532//
533// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000534// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000535//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000536// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
537// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
538// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
539// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000540//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000541// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
542// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
543// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
544// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000545// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
546// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000547//
548// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
549// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
550// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
551// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000552Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000553Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
554 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000555 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000556 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000557 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
558
559 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
560 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
561 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
562
563 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
564 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
565 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
566
567 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
568 }
569
570 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
571 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
572 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
573 // function templates hide function templates with different
574 // return types or template parameter lists.
575 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
576 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
577
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000578 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000579 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
580 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
581 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
582 continue;
583 }
584
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000585 Match = *I;
586 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000587 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000588 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000589 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
590 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
591 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
592 continue;
593 }
594
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000595 Match = *I;
596 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000597 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000598 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000599 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
600 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
601 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000602 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
603 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000604 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
605 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
606 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
607 // template instantiation.
608 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000609 // (C++ 13p1):
610 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
611 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000612 Match = *I;
613 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000614 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000615 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000616
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000617 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000618}
619
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000620bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
621 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000622 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
623 // overloads.
624 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
625 return false;
626
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000627 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
628 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
629
630 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
631 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
632 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
633 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
634 return true;
635
636 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
637 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
638 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
639
640 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
641 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
642 // in the signature, they are overloads.
643
644 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
645 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
646 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
647 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
648 return false;
649
650 FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
651 FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
652
653 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
654 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
655 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
656 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
657 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
658 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000659 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000660 return true;
661
662 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
663 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
664 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
665 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
666 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
667 // signature.
668 //
669 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
670 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000671 //
672 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
673 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
674 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000675 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
676 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
677 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
678 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
679 return true;
680
681 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
682 // cv-qualifiers (if any) on the function itself.
683 //
684 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
685 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
686 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
687 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
688 // can be overloaded.
689 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
690 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
691 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
692 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
693 OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers())
694 return true;
695
696 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
697 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000698}
699
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000700/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
701/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
702/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
703/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000704///
705/// void f(float f);
706/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
707///
708/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
709/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
710/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
711/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
712//
713/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
714/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
715/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
716/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
717/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000718///
719/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
720/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000721/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
722/// permitted.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000723static ImplicitConversionSequence
724TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
725 bool SuppressUserConversions,
726 bool AllowExplicit,
727 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000728 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000729 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
730 ICS.Standard)) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000731 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000732 return ICS;
733 }
734
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000735 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000736 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000737 return ICS;
738 }
739
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000740 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
741 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
742 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
743 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
744 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
745 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
746 // called for those cases.
747 QualType FromType = From->getType();
748 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000749 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
750 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000751 ICS.setStandard();
752 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
753 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
754 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
755
756 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
757 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
758 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
759 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
760 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000761
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000762 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000763 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000764 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000765
766 return ICS;
767 }
768
769 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
770 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
771 // we can perform.
772 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000773 return ICS;
774 }
775
776 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000777 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
778 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000779 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000780 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000781
782 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000783 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000784 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
785 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
786 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
787 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
788 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
789 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
790 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000791 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000792 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000793 QualType FromCanon
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000794 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
795 QualType ToCanon
796 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000797 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000798 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000799 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
800 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000801 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000802 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000803 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000804 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000805 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000806 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000807 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
808 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000809 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000810
811 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
812 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
813 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
814 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
815 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
816 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
817 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000818 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000819 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000820 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000821 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000822 ICS.setAmbiguous();
823 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
824 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
825 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
826 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
827 if (Cand->Viable)
828 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000829 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000830 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000831 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000832
833 return ICS;
834}
835
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000836bool Sema::TryImplicitConversion(InitializationSequence &Sequence,
837 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
838 Expr *Initializer,
839 bool SuppressUserConversions,
840 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
841 bool InOverloadResolution) {
842 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
843 = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, Initializer, Entity.getType(),
844 SuppressUserConversions,
845 AllowExplicitConversions,
846 InOverloadResolution);
847 if (ICS.isBad()) return true;
848
849 // Perform the actual conversion.
850 Sequence.AddConversionSequenceStep(ICS, Entity.getType());
851 return false;
852}
853
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000854/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
855/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns true if there was an
856/// error, false otherwise. The expression From is replaced with the
857/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
858/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
859/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
860bool
861Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType,
862 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
863 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
864 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
865}
866
867bool
868Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType,
869 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
870 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000871 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
872 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
873 AllowExplicit,
874 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000875 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
876}
877
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000878/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
879/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
880static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
881 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) {
882 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
883 return false;
884
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000885 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
886 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
887 // - a pointer
888 // - a member pointer
889 // - a block pointer
890 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
891 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
892 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
893 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
894 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
895 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
896 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
897 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
898 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
899 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
900 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
901 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
902 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
903 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
904 } else {
905 return false;
906 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000907
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000908 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
909 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
910 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
911 return false;
912 }
913
914 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
915 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
916 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
917
918 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
919 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
920 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
921
922 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000923 return true;
924}
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000925
926/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
927/// vector conversion.
928///
929/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
930/// conversion.
931static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
932 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
933 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
934 // conversion.
935 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
936 return false;
937
938 // Identical types require no conversions.
939 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
940 return false;
941
942 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
943 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
944 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
945 // identity conversion.
946 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
947 return false;
948
949 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +0000950 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000951 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
952 return true;
953 }
954 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000955
956 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
957 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
958 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
959 // same size
960 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
961 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +0000962 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
963 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000964 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
965 return true;
966 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000967 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000968
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000969 return false;
970}
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000971
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000972/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
973/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
974/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
975/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
976/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
977/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
978/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
979/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000980static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
981 bool InOverloadResolution,
982 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000983 QualType FromType = From->getType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000984
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000985 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000986 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000987 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +0000988 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000989 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000990 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000991
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000992 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000993 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000994 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000995 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000996 return false;
997
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000998 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000999 }
1000
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001001 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1002 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1003 // (C++ 4p1).
1004
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001005 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001006 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1007 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001008 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1009 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001010 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1011 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1012 FromType = Fn->getType();
1013 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
1014 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
1015 Type *ClassType
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001016 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1017 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001018 }
1019 }
1020
1021 // If the "from" expression takes the address of the overloaded
1022 // function, update the type of the resulting expression accordingly.
1023 if (FromType->getAs<FunctionType>())
1024 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001025 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001026 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001027
1028 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001029 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(FromType,
1030 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001031 } else {
1032 return false;
1033 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001034 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001035 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001036 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
1037 // converted to an rvalue.
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001038 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue();
1039 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001040 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001041 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001042 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001043
1044 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1045 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001046 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1047 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001048 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001049 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1050 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001051 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001052
1053 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1054 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1055 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001056 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001057
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001058 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001059 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001060 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001061
1062 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1063 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1064 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1065 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001066 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1067 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001068 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001069 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001070 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001071 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001072 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001073 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001074
1075 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1076 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1077 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001078 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001079 } else {
1080 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001081 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001082 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001083 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001084
1085 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1086 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1087 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1088 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001089 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1090 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001091 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001092 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001093 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001094 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1095 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001096 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001097 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001098 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001099 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001100 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001101 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001102 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001103 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001104 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001105 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001106 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001107 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1108 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001109 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1110 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1111 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1112 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1113 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1114 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1115 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1116 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1117 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001118 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001119 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001120 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001121 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001122 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001123 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001124 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001125 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1126 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001127 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1128 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001129 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1130 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1131 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001132 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001133 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1134 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1135 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001136 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001137 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001138 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001139 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001140 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001141 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001142 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001143 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1144 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001145 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001146 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001147 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001148 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1149 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001150 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001151 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001152 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001153 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1154 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001155 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1156 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001157 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001158 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001159 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001160 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001161 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1162 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001163 } else {
1164 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001165 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001166 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001167 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001168
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001169 QualType CanonFrom;
1170 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001171 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001172 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001173 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001174 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001175 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1176 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001177 } else {
1178 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001179 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1180
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001181 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001182 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1183 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1184 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001185 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1186 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001187 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1188 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001189 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1190 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001191 FromType = ToType;
1192 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1193 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001194 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001195 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001196
1197 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1198 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001199 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001200 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001201
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001202 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001203}
1204
1205/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1206/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1207/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1208/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001209bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001210 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001211 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001212 if (!To) {
1213 return false;
1214 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001215
1216 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1217 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1218 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1219 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1220 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001221 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1222 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001223 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1224 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1225 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1226 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001227 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001228 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001229 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001230 }
1231
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001232 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1233 }
1234
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001235 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1236 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1237 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1238 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1239 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1240 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
1241 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
1242 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
1243 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
1244 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1245 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
1246 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001247 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1248 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1249 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1250 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1251 return false;
1252
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001253 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001254 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
1255 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001256 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1257 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001258 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001259
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001260 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
1261 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1262 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1263 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
1264 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
1265 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
1266 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
1267 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
1268 // type.
1269 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
1270 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001271 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1272 // unsigned.
1273 bool FromIsSigned;
1274 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001275
1276 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now.
1277 FromIsSigned = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001278
1279 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1280 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001281 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1282 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001283 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1284 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001285 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001286 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001287 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1288 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001289 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001290 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1291 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1292 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1293 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001294 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001295 }
1296 }
1297 }
1298
1299 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1300 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1301 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1302 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1303 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1304 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1305 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001306 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1307 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001308 using llvm::APSInt;
1309 if (From)
1310 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001311 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001312 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001313 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1314 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1315 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001316
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001317 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1318 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1319 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1320 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1321 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001322
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001323 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1324 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1325 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1326 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1327 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001328
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001329 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001330 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001331 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001332
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001333 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1334 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001335 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001336 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001337 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001338
1339 return false;
1340}
1341
1342/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1343/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1344/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001345bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001346 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1347 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001348 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1349 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001350 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1351 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1352 return true;
1353
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001354 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1355 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1356 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1357 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1358 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1359 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1360 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1361 return true;
1362 }
1363
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001364 return false;
1365}
1366
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001367/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1368///
1369/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1370/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001371/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001372bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001373 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001374 if (!FromComplex)
1375 return false;
1376
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001377 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001378 if (!ToComplex)
1379 return false;
1380
1381 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001382 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1383 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1384 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001385}
1386
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001387/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1388/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1389/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1390/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1391/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001392static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001393BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001394 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1395 ASTContext &Context) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001396 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1397 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1398 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001399
1400 /// \brief Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1401 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1402 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1403
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001404 QualType CanonFromPointee
1405 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001406 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001407 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001408
1409 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001410 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001411 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001412 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001413 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001414
1415 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1416 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001417 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1418 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001419 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1420 }
1421
1422 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001423 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1424 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001425
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001426 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1427 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1428 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001429}
1430
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001431static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001432 bool InOverloadResolution,
1433 ASTContext &Context) {
1434 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1435 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1436 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001437 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001438 return !InOverloadResolution;
1439
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001440 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1441 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1442 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001443}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001444
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001445/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1446/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1447/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1448/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1449/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1450/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001451///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001452/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1453/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1454/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1455/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1456/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1457/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001458/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1459/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1460/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001461bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001462 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001463 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001464 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001465 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001466 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1467 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001468 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001469
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001470 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1471 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001472 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001473 ConvertedType = ToType;
1474 return true;
1475 }
1476
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001477 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1478 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001479 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001480 ConvertedType = ToType;
1481 return true;
1482 }
1483 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1484 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001485 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001486 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001487 ConvertedType = ToType;
1488 return true;
1489 }
1490
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001491 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1492 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001493 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001494 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001495 ConvertedType = ToType;
1496 return true;
1497 }
1498
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001499 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001500 if (!ToTypePtr)
1501 return false;
1502
1503 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001504 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001505 ConvertedType = ToType;
1506 return true;
1507 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001508
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001509 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
1510 // , including objective-c pointers.
1511 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1512 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001513 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1514 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1515 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001516 ToType, Context);
1517 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001518 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001519 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001520 if (!FromTypePtr)
1521 return false;
1522
1523 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001524
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001525 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
1526 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1527 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1528 return false;
1529
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001530 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1531 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1532 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001533 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1534 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001535 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001536 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001537 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001538 return true;
1539 }
1540
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001541 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1542 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001543 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001544 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001545 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001546 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001547 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001548 return true;
1549 }
1550
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001551 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001552 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001553 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1554 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1555 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1556 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1557 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1558 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1559 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1560 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1561 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001562 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1563 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001564 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1565 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001566 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001567 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001568 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001569 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001570 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001571 ToType, Context);
1572 return true;
1573 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001574
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001575 return false;
1576}
1577
1578/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1579/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1580/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001581bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001582 QualType& ConvertedType,
1583 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1584 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1585 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001586
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001587 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001588 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1589 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001590 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001591 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001592
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001593 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001594 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1595 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1596 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1597 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1598 return false;
1599
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001600 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001601 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001602 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001603 ConvertedType = ToType;
1604 return true;
1605 }
1606 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001607 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001608 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001609 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001610 /*compare=*/false)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001611 ConvertedType = ToType;
1612 return true;
1613 }
1614 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1615 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1616 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001617 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1618 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1619 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1620 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1621 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1622 return false;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001623 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
1624 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1625 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001626 return true;
1627 }
1628
1629 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1630 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1631 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1632 // complain about it.
1633 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001634 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
1635 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1636 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001637 return true;
1638 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001639 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001640 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001641 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001642 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001643 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001644 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1645 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001646 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001647 // to a block pointer type.
1648 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1649 ConvertedType = ToType;
1650 return true;
1651 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001652 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001653 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001654 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
1655 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1656 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001657 // pointer to any object.
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001658 ConvertedType = ToType;
1659 return true;
1660 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001661 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001662 return false;
1663
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001664 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001665 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001666 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001667 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1668 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001669 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1670 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001671 return false;
1672
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001673 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1674 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1675 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1676 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1677 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1678 // We always complain about this conversion.
1679 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001680 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001681 return true;
1682 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001683 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1684 // as in I* to id.
1685 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1686 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1687 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1688 IncompatibleObjC)) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001689 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001690 return true;
1691 }
1692
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001693 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001694 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1695 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1696 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001697 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001698 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001699 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001700 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001701 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1702 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1703 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1704 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1705 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1706 return false;
1707
1708 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1709 // function types are obviously different.
1710 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1711 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1712 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1713 return false;
1714
1715 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1716 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1717 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1718 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1719 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1720 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1721 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1722 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1723 HasObjCConversion = true;
1724 } else {
1725 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1726 return false;
1727 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001728
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001729 // Check argument types.
1730 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1731 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1732 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1733 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1734 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1735 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1736 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1737 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1738 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1739 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1740 HasObjCConversion = true;
1741 } else {
1742 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1743 return false;
1744 }
1745 }
1746
1747 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1748 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1749 // conversion, but complain about it.
1750 ConvertedType = ToType;
1751 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1752 return true;
1753 }
1754 }
1755
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001756 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001757}
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001758
1759/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
1760/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
1761/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
1762/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
1763bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FunctionProtoType* OldType,
1764 FunctionProtoType* NewType){
1765 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1766 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
1767 NewType->arg_type_begin());
1768
1769 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
1770 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
1771 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
1772 QualType ToType = (*O);
1773 QualType FromType = (*N);
1774 if (ToType != FromType) {
1775 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1776 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00001777 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
1778 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
1779 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
1780 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001781 continue;
1782 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001783 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
1784 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
1785 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
1786 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
1787 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
1788 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001789 }
1790 return false;
1791 }
1792 }
1793 return true;
1794}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001795
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001796/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
1797/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00001798/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001799/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
1800/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
1801/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001802bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001803 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001804 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001805 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001806 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00001807 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001808
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001809 Kind = CK_BitCast;
1810
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001811 if (CXXBoolLiteralExpr* LitBool
1812 = dyn_cast<CXXBoolLiteralExpr>(From->IgnoreParens()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00001813 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && LitBool->getValue() == false)
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001814 Diag(LitBool->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_init_pointer_from_false)
1815 << ToType;
1816
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001817 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
1818 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001819 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
1820 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00001821
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001822 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
1823 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001824 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
1825 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001826 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
1827 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00001828 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001829 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001830 return true;
1831
1832 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001833 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001834 }
1835 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001836 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001837 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001838 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001839 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001840 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
1841 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
1842 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001843 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001844 return false;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001845 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001846 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001847
1848 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
1849 // reasons.
1850 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1851 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
1852
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001853 return false;
1854}
1855
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001856/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1857/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
1858/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
1859/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
1860/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
1861bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001862 QualType ToType,
1863 bool InOverloadResolution,
1864 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001865 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001866 if (!ToTypePtr)
1867 return false;
1868
1869 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001870 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1871 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1872 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001873 ConvertedType = ToType;
1874 return true;
1875 }
1876
1877 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001878 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001879 if (!FromTypePtr)
1880 return false;
1881
1882 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
1883 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
1884 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
1885 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001886
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00001887 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
1888 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
1889 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001890 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
1891 ToClass.getTypePtr());
1892 return true;
1893 }
1894
1895 return false;
1896}
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001897
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001898/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
1899/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001900/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001901/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
1902/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
1903/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001904bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001905 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001906 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001907 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001908 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001909 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001910 if (!FromPtrType) {
1911 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001912 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1913 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001914 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001915 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001916 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001917 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001918
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001919 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001920 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
1921 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001922
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001923 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
1924 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001925
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001926 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
1927 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
1928 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001929
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00001930 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00001931 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001932 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
1933 assert(DerivationOkay &&
1934 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
1935 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001936
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001937 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
1938 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001939 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
1940 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
1941 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
1942 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001943 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001944
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00001945 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001946 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
1947 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
1948 << From->getSourceRange();
1949 return true;
1950 }
1951
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001952 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00001953 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
1954 Paths.front(),
1955 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001956
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001957 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00001958 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001959 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001960 return false;
1961}
1962
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001963/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
1964/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
1965/// (C++ 4.4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001966bool
1967Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001968 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1969 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1970
1971 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
1972 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00001973 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001974 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001975
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001976 // (C++ 4.4p4):
1977 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
1978 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
1979 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001980 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00001981 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001982 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
1983 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
1984 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00001985 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001986 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
1987 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001988 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001989
1990 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
1991 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregorea2d4212008-10-22 00:38:21 +00001992 if (!ToType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromType))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001993 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001994
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001995 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
1996 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
1997 if (FromType.getCVRQualifiers() != ToType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001998 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001999 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002000
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002001 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2002 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002003 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002004 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToType.isConstQualified();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002005 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002006
2007 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2008 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2009 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2010 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2011 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002012 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002013}
2014
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002015/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2016/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2017/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2018/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2019/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2020/// false and User is unspecified.
2021///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002022/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2023/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2024/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002025static OverloadingResult
2026IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2027 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2028 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2029 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002030 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2031 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2032
2033 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2034 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002035 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002036 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2037 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2038 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2039 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2040 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2041 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2042 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2043 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002044 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002045 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002046 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002047 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2048
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002049 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag())) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002050 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2051 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2052 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002053 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002054 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002055 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002056 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2057 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2058
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002059 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2060 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2061 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002062 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002063 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002064 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002065 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2066 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002067 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00002068
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002069 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002070 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002071 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002072 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2073 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
2074 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2075 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2076 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002077 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002078 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2079 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002080 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2081 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2082 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2083 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002084 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002085 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002086 }
2087 }
2088
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002089 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2090 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002091 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2092 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002093 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002094 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002095 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002096 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002097 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2098 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002099 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002100 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002101 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002102 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002103 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2104 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002105 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2106 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2107 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2108
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002109 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2110 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002111 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2112 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002113 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002114 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002115
2116 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2117 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002118 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2119 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2120 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002121 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002122 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2123 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002124 }
2125 }
2126 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002127 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002128
2129 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002130 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002131 case OR_Success:
2132 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2133 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2134 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
2135 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2136 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2137 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2138 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2139 // the argument of the constructor.
2140 //
2141 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2142 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2143 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2144 else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002145 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002146 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002147 }
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002148 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2149 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2150 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2151 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2152 return OR_Success;
2153 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2154 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
2155 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2156 //
2157 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2158 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2159 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2160 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2161 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2162 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
2163 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002164
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002165 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2166 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2167 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2168 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2169 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2170 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2171 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2172 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2173 // 13.3.3.1).
2174 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2175 return OR_Success;
2176 } else {
2177 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002178 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002179 }
2180
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002181 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2182 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2183 case OR_Deleted:
2184 // No conversion here! We're done.
2185 return OR_Deleted;
2186
2187 case OR_Ambiguous:
2188 return OR_Ambiguous;
2189 }
2190
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002191 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002192}
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002193
2194bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002195Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002196 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002197 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002198 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002199 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002200 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002201 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2202 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2203 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2204 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2205 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2206 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2207 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2208 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2209 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002210 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002211 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002212 return true;
2213}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002214
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002215/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2216/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2217/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002218static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2219CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2220 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2221 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002222{
2223 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2224 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2225 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2226 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2227 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2228 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2229 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2230 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002231 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002232 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2233 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2234 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2235 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2236 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002237 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2238 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2239 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2240 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002241
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002242 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2243 // the same kind.
2244 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2245 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2246
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002247 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2248 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2249 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002250 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002251 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002252 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002253 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2254 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2255 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2256 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2257 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2258 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002259 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002260 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002261 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2262 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002263 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2264 }
2265
2266 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2267}
2268
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002269static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2270 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2271 Qualifiers Quals;
2272 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
2273 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
2274 }
2275
2276 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2277}
2278
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002279// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2280// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2281static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2282compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2283 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2284 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2285 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2286 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2287
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002288 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
2289 // any non-identity conversion sequence
2290 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2291 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2292 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2293 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2294 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2295 }
2296
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002297 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2298 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2299 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2300 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2301 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2302 else
2303 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002304 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002305 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2306
2307 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2308 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2309 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2310 }
2311
2312 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2313 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2314 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2315 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2316
2317 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2318 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2319 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2320 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2321
2322 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2323}
2324
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002325/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2326/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2327/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002328static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2329CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2330 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2331 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002332{
2333 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2334 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2335
2336 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2337 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2338 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2339 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2340 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002341 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002342 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002343 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002344
2345 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2346 // defined below), or, if not that,
2347 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2348 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2349 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2350 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2351 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2352 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002353
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002354 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2355 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2356 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002357
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002358 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2359 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2360 // that is such a conversion.
2361 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2362 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2363 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2364 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2365
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002366 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2367 //
2368 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002369 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2370 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2371 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002372 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002373 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002374 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002375 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002376 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2377 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2378 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002379 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2380 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002381 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2382 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2383 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002384 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002385 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002386 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002387 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2388 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2389 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2390 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002391 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2392 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002393
2394 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2395 // conversion, if we need to.
2396 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002397 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002398 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002399 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002400
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002401 QualType FromPointee1
2402 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2403 QualType FromPointee2
2404 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002405
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002406 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002407 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002408 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002409 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2410
2411 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2412 // other, it is the better one.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002413 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2414 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002415 if (FromIface1 && FromIface1) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002416 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002417 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002418 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002419 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2420 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002421 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002422
2423 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2424 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002425 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002426 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002427 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002428
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002429 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002430 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2431 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2432 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
2433 // without a ref-qualifier, and S1 binds an rvalue reference to an
2434 // rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference.
Sebastian Redl4c0cd852009-03-29 15:27:50 +00002435 // FIXME: We don't know if we're dealing with the implicit object parameter,
2436 // or if the member function in this case has a ref qualifier.
2437 // (Of course, we don't have ref qualifiers yet.)
2438 if (SCS1.RRefBinding != SCS2.RRefBinding)
2439 return SCS1.RRefBinding ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2440 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002441
2442 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2443 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2444 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2445 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2446 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2447 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002448 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2449 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002450 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2451 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002452 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002453 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2454 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002455 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002456 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2457 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002458 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002459 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002460 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002461 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002462 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2463 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2464 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2465 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2466 }
2467 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002468
2469 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2470}
2471
2472/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2473/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002474/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2475ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002476CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2477 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2478 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002479 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002480 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2481 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2482 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2483 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2484 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2485 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2486 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2487 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2488
2489 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2490 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002491 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2492 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002493 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2494 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002495 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002496 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2497 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002498
2499 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2500 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002501 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002502 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2503
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002504 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2505 // for comparison.
2506 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002507 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002508 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002509 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002510
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002511 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002512 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002513 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002514 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2515 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2516 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002517 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002518 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2519 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2520 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2521 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2522 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2523 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2524 // about how the sequences rank.
2525 ;
2526 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2527 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2528 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2529 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2530 // qualifiers.
2531 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002532
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002533 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2534 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2535 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2536 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2537 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2538 // qualifiers.
2539 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002540
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002541 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2542 } else {
2543 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2544 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2545 }
2546
2547 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002548 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002549 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002550 }
2551
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002552 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2553 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2554 switch (Result) {
2555 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002556 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002557 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2558 break;
2559
2560 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2561 break;
2562
2563 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002564 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002565 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2566 break;
2567 }
2568
2569 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002570}
2571
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002572/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2573/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002574/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2575/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2576/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002577ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002578CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
2579 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2580 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002581 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002582 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002583 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002584 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002585
2586 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2587 // conversion, if we need to.
2588 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002589 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002590 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002591 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002592
2593 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002594 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2595 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
2596 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
2597 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002598
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002599 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002600 //
2601 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
2602 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002603 //
2604 // For Objective-C, we let A, B, and C also be Objective-C
2605 // interfaces.
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002606
2607 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002608 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002609 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2610 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
2611 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
2612 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002613 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002614 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002615 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002616 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002617 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002618 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002619 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002620 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002621
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002622 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2623 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2624 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface1 = ToPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2625 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface2 = ToPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002626
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002627 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002628 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002629 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002630 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002631 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002632 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002633
2634 if (ToIface1 && ToIface2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002635 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface2, ToIface1))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002636 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002637 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface1, ToIface2))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002638 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2639 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002640 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002641
2642 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
2643 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002644 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002645 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002646 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002647 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002648
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002649 if (FromIface1 && FromIface2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002650 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002651 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002652 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002653 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2654 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002655 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002656 }
2657
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002658 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002659 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
2660 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
2661 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
2662 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
2663 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2664 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
2665 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2666 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
2667 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2668 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
2669 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2670 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
2671 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
2672 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
2673 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
2674 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2675 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2676 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2677 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002678 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002679 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002680 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002681 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002682 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002683 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2684 }
2685 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
2686 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002687 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002688 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002689 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002690 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2691 }
2692 }
2693
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002694 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002695 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002696 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
2697 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2698 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002699 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2700 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2701 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002702 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002703 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002704 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2705 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002706
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002707 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002708 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
2709 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2710 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002711 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2712 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2713 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002714 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002715 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002716 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2717 }
2718 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002719
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002720 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2721}
2722
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002723/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
2724/// determine whether they are reference-related,
2725/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
2726/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
2727/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
2728/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
2729/// type being initialized.
2730Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
2731Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
2732 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002733 bool &DerivedToBase,
2734 bool &ObjCConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002735 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
2736 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
2737 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
2738
2739 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
2740 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
2741 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
2742 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2743 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
2744
2745 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
2746 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
2747 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
2748 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002749 DerivedToBase = false;
2750 ObjCConversion = false;
2751 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
2752 // Nothing to do.
2753 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002754 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
2755 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002756 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
2757 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
2758 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
2759 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002760 else
2761 return Ref_Incompatible;
2762
2763 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
2764 // least).
2765
2766 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2767 // for comparison.
2768 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
2769 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
2770 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
2771 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
2772
2773 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
2774 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
2775 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
2776 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
2777 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
2778 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
2779 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
2780 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers())
2781 return Ref_Compatible;
2782 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2783 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
2784 else
2785 return Ref_Related;
2786}
2787
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002788/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002789/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
2790static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002791FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
2792 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
2793 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
2794 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002795 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
2796 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
2797 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2798
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002799 QualType ToType
2800 = AllowRvalues? DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType()
2801 : DeclType;
2802
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002803 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
2804 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
2805 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
2806 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
2807 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
2808 NamedDecl *D = *I;
2809 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2810 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2811 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2812
2813 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
2814 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2815 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2816 if (ConvTemplate)
2817 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
2818 else
2819 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
2820
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002821 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
2822 // explicit conversions, skip it.
2823 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
2824 continue;
2825
2826 if (AllowRvalues) {
2827 bool DerivedToBase = false;
2828 bool ObjCConversion = false;
2829 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002830 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
2831 DeclLoc,
2832 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
2833 .getUnqualifiedType(),
2834 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
2835 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion) ==
2836 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002837 continue;
2838 } else {
2839 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
2840 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
2841 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
2842
2843 const ReferenceType *RefType =
2844 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2845 if (!RefType ||
2846 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
2847 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
2848 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002849 }
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002850
2851 if (ConvTemplate)
2852 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
2853 Init, ToType, CandidateSet);
2854 else
2855 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
2856 ToType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002857 }
2858
2859 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002860 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002861 case OR_Success:
2862 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
2863 //
2864 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
2865 // applying a conversion function to the argument
2866 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
2867 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
2868 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
2869 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
2870 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
2871 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
2872 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
2873 return false;
2874
2875 ICS.setUserDefined();
2876 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2877 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2878 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
2879 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
2880 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
2881 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
2882 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
2883 return true;
2884
2885 case OR_Ambiguous:
2886 ICS.setAmbiguous();
2887 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
2888 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
2889 if (Cand->Viable)
2890 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
2891 return true;
2892
2893 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2894 case OR_Deleted:
2895 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
2896 // conversion; continue with other checks.
2897 return false;
2898 }
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00002899
2900 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002901}
2902
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002903/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
2904/// initialization.
2905static ImplicitConversionSequence
2906TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
2907 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
2908 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00002909 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002910 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
2911
2912 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
2913 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
2914 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
2915
2916 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
2917 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
2918
2919 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
2920 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
2921 // type of the resulting function.
2922 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
2923 DeclAccessPair Found;
2924 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
2925 false, Found))
2926 T2 = Fn->getType();
2927 }
2928
2929 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
2930 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
2931 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002932 bool ObjCConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002933 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002934 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002935 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
2936 ObjCConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002937
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002938
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002939 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00002940 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
2941 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
2942
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002943 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
2944 // The next bullet point (T1 is a function) is pretty much equivalent to this
2945 // one, so it's handled here.
2946 if (!isRValRef || T1->isFunctionType()) {
2947 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
2948 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
2949 //
2950 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
2951 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
2952 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002953 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002954 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
2955 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
2956 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
2957 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
2958 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
2959 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
2960 ICS.setStandard();
2961 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002962 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
2963 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
2964 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002965 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
2966 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
2967 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
2968 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
2969 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
2970 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
2971 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
2972 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
2973 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002974
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002975 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
2976 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
2977 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
2978 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002979 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002980 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002981
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002982 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
2983 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
2984 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
2985 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
2986 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
2987 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
2988 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
2989 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
2990 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
2991 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002992 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
2993 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
2994 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002995 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002996 }
2997 }
2998
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002999 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3000 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
3001 // shall be an rvalue reference and the initializer expression shall be
3002 // an rvalue or have a function type.
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003003 //
3004 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3005 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3006 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3007 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3008 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3009 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3010 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003011 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3012 // go together.
3013 if ((!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified()) ||
3014 (isRValRef && InitCategory.isLValue()))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003015 return ICS;
3016
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003017 // -- If T1 is a function type, then
3018 // -- if T2 is the same type as T1, the reference is bound to the
3019 // initializer expression lvalue;
3020 // -- if T2 is a class type and the initializer expression can be
3021 // implicitly converted to an lvalue of type T1 [...], the
3022 // reference is bound to the function lvalue that is the result
3023 // of the conversion;
3024 // This is the same as for the lvalue case above, so it was handled there.
3025 // -- otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3026 // This is the one difference to the lvalue case.
3027 if (T1->isFunctionType())
3028 return ICS;
3029
3030 // -- Otherwise, if T2 is a class type and
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00003031 // -- the initializer expression is an rvalue and "cv1 T1"
3032 // is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003033 //
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00003034 // -- T1 is not reference-related to T2 and the initializer
3035 // expression can be implicitly converted to an rvalue
3036 // of type "cv3 T3" (this conversion is selected by
3037 // enumerating the applicable conversion functions
3038 // (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best one through overload
3039 // resolution (13.3)),
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003040 //
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00003041 // then the reference is bound to the initializer
3042 // expression rvalue in the first case and to the object
3043 // that is the result of the conversion in the second case
3044 // (or, in either case, to the appropriate base class
3045 // subobject of the object).
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003046 if (T2->isRecordType()) {
3047 // First case: "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2". This is a
3048 // direct binding in C++0x but not in C++03.
3049 if (InitCategory.isRValue() &&
3050 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
3051 ICS.setStandard();
3052 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
3053 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3054 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3055 : ICK_Identity;
3056 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3057 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3058 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3059 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3060 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3061 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3062 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x;
3063 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
3064 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
3065 return ICS;
3066 }
3067
3068 // Second case: not reference-related.
3069 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3070 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
3071 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3072 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3073 AllowExplicit))
3074 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003075 }
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003076
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003077 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3078 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3079 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3080 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3081 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3082 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3083 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3084 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3085 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3086 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3087 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3088 // initialization fails.
3089 return ICS;
3090 }
3091
3092 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3093 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3094 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3095 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3096 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3097 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3098 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3099 return ICS;
3100
3101 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003102 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3103 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3104 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3105 // underlying type of the reference according to
3106 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3107 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3108 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3109 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3110 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003111 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3112 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
3113 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003114
3115 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3116 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3117 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3118 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
3119 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3120 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
3121 ICS.UserDefined.After.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
3122 }
3123 return ICS;
3124}
3125
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003126/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3127/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3128/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3129/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003130/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003131/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003132static ImplicitConversionSequence
3133TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregordcd27ff2010-04-16 17:53:55 +00003134 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003135 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003136 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003137 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003138 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3139 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003140 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003141
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003142 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3143 SuppressUserConversions,
3144 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
3145 InOverloadResolution);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003146}
3147
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003148/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3149/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3150/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003151static ImplicitConversionSequence
3152TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
3153 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3154 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3155 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003156 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3157 // const volatile object.
3158 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3159 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003160 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003161
3162 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3163 // to exit early.
3164 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003165
3166 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003167 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003168 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003169 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3170
3171 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003172
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003173 // The implicit object parameter is has the type "reference to cv X",
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003174 // where X is the class of which the function is a member
3175 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p4). However, when finding an implicit
3176 // conversion sequence for the argument, we are not allowed to
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003177 // create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003178 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3179 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3180 // non-constant references.
3181
3182 // First check the qualifiers. We don't care about lvalue-vs-rvalue
3183 // with the implicit object parameter (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003184 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003185 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
3186 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003187 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003188 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3189 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003190 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003191 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003192
3193 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3194 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003195 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003196 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3197 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3198 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003199 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003200 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003201 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003202 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3203 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003204 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003205 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003206
3207 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003208 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003209 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3210 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003211 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003212 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003213 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3214 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Sebastian Redlf69a94a2009-03-29 22:46:24 +00003215 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003216 return ICS;
3217}
3218
3219/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3220/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3221/// expression.
3222bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003223Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *&From,
3224 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003225 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003226 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003227 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003228 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003229 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003230
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003231 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003232 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3233 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
3234 } else {
3235 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3236 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
3237 }
3238
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003239 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3240 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003241 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003242 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), Method,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003243 Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003244 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3245 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3246 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3247 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3248 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3249 if (CVR) {
3250 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3251 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3252 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3253 << From->getSourceRange();
3254 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3255 << Method->getDeclName();
3256 return true;
3257 }
3258 }
3259
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003260 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003261 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003262 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003263 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003264
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003265 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003266 return PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003267
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003268 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003269 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00003270 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003271 return false;
3272}
3273
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003274/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3275/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003276static ImplicitConversionSequence
3277TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003278 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003279 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003280 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3281 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003282 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00003283 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003284}
3285
3286/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3287/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
3288bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *&From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003289 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003290 if (!ICS.isBad())
3291 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003292
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003293 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003294 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3295 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
3296 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
3297 return true;
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003298}
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003299
3300/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3301/// expression From to 'id'.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003302static ImplicitConversionSequence
3303TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3304 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3305 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3306 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3307 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3308 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
3309 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003310}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003311
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003312/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3313/// of the expression From to 'id'.
3314bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *&From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003315 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003316 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003317 if (!ICS.isBad())
3318 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
3319 return true;
3320}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003321
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003322/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
3323/// enumeration type.
3324///
3325/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3326/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3327/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3328///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003329/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3330/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003331///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003332/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3333///
3334/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3335/// have integral or enumeration type.
3336///
3337/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3338/// incomplete class type.
3339///
3340/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3341/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3342/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3343///
3344/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3345/// showing which conversion was picked.
3346///
3347/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3348/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3349///
3350/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
3351/// usable conversion function.
3352///
3353/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3354/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3355///
3356/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3357/// successful.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003358ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003359Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003360 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3361 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3362 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3363 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3364 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003365 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3366 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003367 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3368 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003369 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003370
3371 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3372 QualType T = From->getType();
3373 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003374 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003375
3376 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3377
3378 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
3379 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3380 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3381 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3382 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3383 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003384 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003385 }
3386
3387 // We must have a complete class type.
3388 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003389 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003390
3391 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3392 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3393 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3394 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3395 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3396
3397 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3398 E = Conversions->end();
3399 I != E;
3400 ++I) {
3401 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3402 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3403 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3404 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3405 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3406 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3407 else
3408 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3409 }
3410 }
3411
3412 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3413 case 0:
3414 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3415 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3416 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3417 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3418
3419 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3420 // conversion; use it.
3421 QualType ConvTy
3422 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3423 std::string TypeStr;
3424 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
3425
3426 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3427 << T << ConvTy
3428 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3429 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3430 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3431 ")");
3432 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3433 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3434
3435 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
3436 // explicit conversion function.
3437 if (isSFINAEContext())
3438 return ExprError();
3439
3440 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003441 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003442 }
3443
3444 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
3445 break;
3446
3447 case 1: {
3448 // Apply this conversion.
3449 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
3450 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003451
3452 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3453 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3454 QualType ConvTy
3455 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3456 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
3457 if (isSFINAEContext())
3458 return ExprError();
3459
3460 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
3461 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
3462 }
3463
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003464 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003465 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003466 break;
3467 }
3468
3469 default:
3470 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
3471 << T << From->getSourceRange();
3472 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
3473 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
3474 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
3475 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3476 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
3477 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3478 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003479 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003480 }
3481
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003482 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003483 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3484 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003485
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003486 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003487}
3488
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003489/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003490/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
3491/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
3492/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003493///
3494/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
3495/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
3496/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003497void
3498Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003499 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003500 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003501 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00003502 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003503 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003504 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003505 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003506 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003507 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003508 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003509
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003510 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003511 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
3512 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
3513 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
3514 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
3515 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003516 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
3517 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
3518 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003519 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003520 QualType(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003521 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003522 return;
3523 }
3524 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
3525 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003526 }
3527
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00003528 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003529 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003530
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003531 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003532 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003533
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003534 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
3535 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
3536 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
3537 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
3538 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
3539 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00003540 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00003541 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
3542 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003543 return;
3544 }
3545
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003546 // Add this candidate
3547 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3548 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003549 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003550 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003551 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003552 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003554
3555 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3556
3557 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3558 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3559 // list (8.3.5).
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00003560 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
3561 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003562 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003563 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003564 return;
3565 }
3566
3567 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3568 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3569 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3570 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3571 // exactly m parameters.
3572 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003573 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003574 // Not enough arguments.
3575 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003576 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003577 return;
3578 }
3579
3580 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3581 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003582 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3583 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3584 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3585 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3586 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3587 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3588 // parameter of F.
3589 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003590 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003591 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00003592 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003593 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003594 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
3595 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003596 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003597 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003598 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003599 } else {
3600 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3601 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3602 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003603 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003604 }
3605 }
3606}
3607
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003608/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
3609/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003610void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003611 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3612 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3613 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003614 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003615 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
3616 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003617 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003618 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003619 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
3620 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003621 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3622 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003623 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003624 SuppressUserConversions);
3625 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003626 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003627 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3628 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003629 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003630 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003631 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003632 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003633 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003634 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003635 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003636 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003637 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003638 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
3639 SuppressUserConversions);
3640 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003641 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003642}
3643
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003644/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
3645/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003646void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003647 QualType ObjectType,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003648 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3649 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003650 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003651 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003652 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003653
3654 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
3655 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
3656
3657 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
3658 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3659 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003660 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3661 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003662 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003663 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003664 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003665 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003666 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003667 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003668 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003669 }
3670}
3671
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003672/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
3673/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
3674/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
3675/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
3676/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
3677/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003678/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003679void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003680Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00003681 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
3682 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003683 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003684 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003685 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003686 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003687 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003688 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
3689 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003690
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003691 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
3692 return;
3693
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003694 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003695 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003696
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003697 // Add this candidate
3698 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3699 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003700 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003701 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003702 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003703 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003704
3705 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3706
3707 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3708 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3709 // list (8.3.5).
3710 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
3711 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003712 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003713 return;
3714 }
3715
3716 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3717 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3718 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3719 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3720 // exactly m parameters.
3721 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
3722 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
3723 // Not enough arguments.
3724 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003725 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003726 return;
3727 }
3728
3729 Candidate.Viable = true;
3730 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
3731
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003732 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003733 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
3734 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
3735 else {
3736 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
3737 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003738 Candidate.Conversions[0]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003739 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, Method,
3740 ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003741 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003742 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003743 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003744 return;
3745 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003746 }
3747
3748 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3749 // arguments.
3750 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3751 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3752 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3753 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3754 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3755 // parameter of F.
3756 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003757 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003758 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003759 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00003760 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003761 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003762 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003763 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003764 break;
3765 }
3766 } else {
3767 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3768 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3769 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003770 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003771 }
3772 }
3773}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00003774
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003775/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
3776/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
3777/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003778void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003779Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003780 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003781 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003782 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003783 QualType ObjectType,
3784 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003785 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003786 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003787 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
3788 return;
3789
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003790 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003791 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003792 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003793 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003794 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
3795 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
3796 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
3797 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
3798 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003799 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003800 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3801 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003802 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003803 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003804 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3805 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
3806 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
3807 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
3808 Candidate.Viable = false;
3809 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
3810 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
3811 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
3812 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
3813 Info);
3814 return;
3815 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003816
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003817 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
3818 // deduction as a candidate.
3819 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003820 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003821 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003822 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00003823 ActingContext, ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003824 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003825}
3826
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003827/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
3828/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
3829/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003830void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003831Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003832 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003833 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003834 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3835 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003836 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003837 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
3838 return;
3839
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003840 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003841 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003842 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003843 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003844 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
3845 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
3846 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
3847 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
3848 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003849 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003850 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3851 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003852 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003853 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003854 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3855 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003856 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003857 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
3858 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003859 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003860 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
3861 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003862 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
3863 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003864 return;
3865 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003866
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003867 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
3868 // deduction as a candidate.
3869 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003870 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003871 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003872}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003873
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003874/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003875/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003876/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003877/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003878/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
3879/// conversion function produces).
3880void
3881Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003882 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003883 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003884 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3885 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003886 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
3887 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003888 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003889 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
3890 return;
3891
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003892 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003893 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003894
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003895 // Add this candidate
3896 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3897 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003898 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003899 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003900 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003901 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003902 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003903 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003904 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003905 Candidate.Viable = true;
3906 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003907
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00003908 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
3909 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
3910 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
3911 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003912 //
3913 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
3914 // object parameter.
3915 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
3916 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
3917 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
3918 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
3919 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3920
3921 Candidate.Conversions[0]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003922 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), Conversion,
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003923 ConversionContext);
3924
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003925 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003926 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003927 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003928 return;
3929 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003930
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00003931 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
3932 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
3933 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
3934 QualType FromCanon
3935 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
3936 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
3937 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
3938 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00003939 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00003940 return;
3941 }
3942
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003943 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
3944 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
3945 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
3946 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
3947 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
3948 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
3949 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
3950 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003951 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003952 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003953 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
3954 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003955 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00003956 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003957
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00003958 QualType CallResultType
3959 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
3960 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), CallResultType, 0)) {
3961 Candidate.Viable = false;
3962 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
3963 return;
3964 }
3965
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003966 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Conversion->getConversionType());
3967
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003968 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003969 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
3970 // allocator).
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003971 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00003972 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003973 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003974 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00003975 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003976 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003977
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003978 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003979 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
3980 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00003981
3982 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
3983 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
3984 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
3985 // shall have exact match rank.
3986 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
3987 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
3988 Candidate.Viable = false;
3989 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
3990 }
3991
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003992 break;
3993
3994 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
3995 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00003996 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003997 break;
3998
3999 default:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004000 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004001 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4002 }
4003}
4004
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004005/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4006/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4007/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4008/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4009/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004010void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004011Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004012 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004013 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004014 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4015 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4016 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4017 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4018
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004019 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4020 return;
4021
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004022 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004023 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4024 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004025 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004026 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004027 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4028 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4029 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4030 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4031 Candidate.Viable = false;
4032 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4033 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4034 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4035 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
4036 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004037 return;
4038 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004039
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004040 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4041 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4042 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004043 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004044 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004045}
4046
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004047/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4048/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4049/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4050/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4051/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4052void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004053 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004054 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004055 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004056 QualType ObjectType,
4057 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004058 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004059 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4060 return;
4061
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004062 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004063 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004064
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004065 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4066 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004067 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004068 Candidate.Function = 0;
4069 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4070 Candidate.Viable = true;
4071 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004072 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004073 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4074
4075 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4076 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004077 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004078 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, Conversion,
4079 ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004080 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004081 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004082 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004083 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004084 return;
4085 }
4086
4087 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4088 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4089 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004090 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004091 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004092 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004093 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004094 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004095 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4096 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4097
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004098 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004099 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4100
4101 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4102 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4103 // list (8.3.5).
4104 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4105 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004106 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004107 return;
4108 }
4109
4110 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4111 // we have enough arguments.
4112 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4113 // Not enough arguments.
4114 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004115 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004116 return;
4117 }
4118
4119 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4120 // arguments.
4121 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4122 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4123 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4124 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4125 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4126 // parameter of F.
4127 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004128 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004129 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004130 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004131 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004132 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004133 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004134 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004135 break;
4136 }
4137 } else {
4138 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4139 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4140 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004141 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004142 }
4143 }
4144}
4145
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004146/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4147/// member functions.
4148///
4149/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4150/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4151/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4152/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4153/// [over.match.oper]).
4154void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4155 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4156 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4157 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4158 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004159 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4160
4161 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4162 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4163 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4164 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4165 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4166 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4167 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4168 // constructed as follows:
4169 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004170
4171 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4172 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4173 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4174 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004175 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004176 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004177 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004178 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004179
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004180 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4181 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4182 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4183
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004184 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004185 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4186 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004187 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004188 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004189 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004190 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004191 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004192}
4193
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004194/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4195/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4196/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004197/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4198/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004199/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4200/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4201/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004202void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004203 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004204 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004205 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4206 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004207 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004208 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004209
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004210 // Add this candidate
4211 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4212 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004213 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004214 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004215 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004216 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004217 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4218 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4219 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4220
4221 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4222 // arguments.
4223 Candidate.Viable = true;
4224 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
4225 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004226 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4227 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4228 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4229 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4230 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4231 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004232 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004233 //
4234 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4235 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4236 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4237 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004238 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004239 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004240 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004241 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4242 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004243 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004244 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004245 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004246 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004247 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004248 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004249 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004250 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004251 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004252 break;
4253 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004254 }
4255}
4256
4257/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4258/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4259/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4260/// enumeration types.
4261class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4262 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004263 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004264
4265 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4266 /// built-in candidates.
4267 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4268
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004269 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4270 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4271 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4272
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004273 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4274 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4275 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4276
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004277 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
4278 /// candidates.
4279 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004280
4281 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
4282 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
4283
4284 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
4285 /// were present in the candidate set.
4286 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
4287
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004288 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4289 /// candidate type set.
4290 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004291
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004292 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4293 ASTContext &Context;
4294
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004295 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4296 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004297 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004298
4299public:
4300 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004301 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004302
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004303 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004304 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
4305 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
4306 SemaRef(SemaRef),
4307 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004308
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004309 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
4310 SourceLocation Loc,
4311 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004312 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4313 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004314
4315 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4316 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4317
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004318 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004319 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4320
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004321 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4322 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4323
4324 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4325 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4326
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004327 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4328 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4329
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004330 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004331 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004332
4333 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4334 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004335
4336 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
4337 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004338};
4339
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004340/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004341/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4342/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4343/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4344/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4345/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4346/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004347///
4348/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004349bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004350BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4351 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004352
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004353 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004354 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004355 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004356
4357 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004358 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004359 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004360 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004361 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004362 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004363 buildObjCPtr = true;
4364 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004365 else
4366 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!");
4367 }
4368 else
4369 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
4370
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004371 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4372 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4373 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4374 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4375 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4376 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004377 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004378 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004379 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004380 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4381 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
4382
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004383 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4384 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4385 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004386 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4387 // in the types.
4388 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4389 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004390 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004391 if (!buildObjCPtr)
4392 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
4393 else
4394 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004395 }
4396
4397 return true;
4398}
4399
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004400/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
4401/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4402/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4403/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4404/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4405/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4406/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004407///
4408/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004409bool
4410BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
4411 QualType Ty) {
4412 // Insert this type.
4413 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
4414 return false;
4415
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004416 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4417 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004418
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004419 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004420 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4421 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4422 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4423 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4424 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4425 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004426 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
4427
4428 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
4429 // qualifiers.
4430 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
4431 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4432 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
4433
4434 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004435 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
4436 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004437 }
4438
4439 return true;
4440}
4441
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004442/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
4443/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004444/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
4445/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004446/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
4447/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
4448/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
4449/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004450void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004451BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004452 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004453 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004454 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4455 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004456 // Only deal with canonical types.
4457 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
4458
4459 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
4460 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004461 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004462 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
4463
4464 // We don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004465 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004466
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004467 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
4468 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
4469 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
4470
Sebastian Redl65ae2002009-11-05 16:36:20 +00004471 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
4472 if (Ty->isArrayType())
4473 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004474
4475 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
4476 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
4477 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
4478
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004479 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
4480 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
4481 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004482 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
4483 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004484 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004485 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004486 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4487 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
4488 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
4489 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004490 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004491 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004492 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004493 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004494 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
4495 // extension.
4496 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004497 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004498 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
4499 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
4500 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
4501 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004502
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004503 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
4504 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4505 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4506 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
4507 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
4508 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4509 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4510 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004511
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004512 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
4513 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
4514 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
4515 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004516
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004517 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4518 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
4519 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
4520 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004521 }
4522 }
4523 }
4524}
4525
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004526/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
4527/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
4528/// given type to the candidate set.
4529static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
4530 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004531 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004532 unsigned NumArgs,
4533 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4534 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004535
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004536 // T& operator=(T&, T)
4537 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
4538 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4539 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4540 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004541
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004542 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
4543 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004544 ParamTypes[0]
4545 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004546 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4547 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004548 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004549 }
4550}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004551
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004552/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
4553/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004554static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
4555 Qualifiers VRQuals;
4556 const RecordType *TyRec;
4557 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
4558 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00004559 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004560 else
4561 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4562 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004563 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004564 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4565 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4566 return VRQuals;
4567 }
4568
4569 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00004570 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
4571 return VRQuals;
4572
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004573 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004574 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004575
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004576 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004577 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004578 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4579 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4580 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4581 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004582 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
4583 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4584 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
4585 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
4586 // as see them.
4587 bool done = false;
4588 while (!done) {
4589 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4590 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
4591 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
4592 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
4593 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
4594 else
4595 done = true;
4596 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
4597 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4598 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
4599 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4600 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
4601 return VRQuals;
4602 }
4603 }
4604 }
4605 return VRQuals;
4606}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004607
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004608namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004609
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004610/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
4611/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
4612/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
4613/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
4614class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004615 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
4616 Sema &S;
4617 Expr **Args;
4618 unsigned NumArgs;
4619 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004620 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004621 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
4622 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004623
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004624 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
4625 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004626 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
4627 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004628 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
4629 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
4630 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
4631 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
4632 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
4633 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
4634 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
4635
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004636 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
4637 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
4638 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
4639 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
4640 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
4641 // Start of promoted types.
4642 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
4643 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
4644 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004645
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004646 // Start of integral types.
4647 &ASTContext::IntTy,
4648 &ASTContext::LongTy,
4649 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
4650 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
4651 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
4652 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
4653 // End of promoted types.
4654
4655 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
4656 &ASTContext::CharTy,
4657 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
4658 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
4659 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
4660 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
4661 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
4662 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
4663 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
4664 // End of integral types.
4665 // FIXME: What about complex?
4666 };
4667 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
4668 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004669
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00004670 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
4671 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
4672 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
4673 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
4674 // The rules are basically:
4675 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
4676 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
4677 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
4678 // - use the larger type
4679 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
4680 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
4681 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
4682 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
4683 // better not to make any assumptions).
4684 enum PromotedType {
4685 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
4686 };
4687 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
4688 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
4689 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
4690 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
4691 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
4692 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
4693 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
4694 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
4695 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
4696 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
4697 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
4698 };
4699
4700 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
4701 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
4702 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
4703
4704 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004705 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00004706
4707 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
4708 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004709 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
4710 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00004711 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
4712 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
4713
4714 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
4715 if (LW > RW) return LT;
4716 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
4717
4718 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
4719 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
4720 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
4721 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
4722 }
4723
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00004724 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
4725 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004726 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
4727 bool HasVolatile) {
4728 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
4729 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
4730 S.Context.IntTy
4731 };
4732
4733 // Non-volatile version.
4734 if (NumArgs == 1)
4735 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4736 else
4737 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4738
4739 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
4740 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
4741 if (HasVolatile) {
4742 ParamTypes[0] =
4743 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
4744 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
4745 if (NumArgs == 1)
4746 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4747 else
4748 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4749 }
4750 }
4751
4752public:
4753 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
4754 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4755 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004756 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004757 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
4758 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
4759 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
4760 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004761 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
4762 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004763 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
4764 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
4765 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004766 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004767 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004768 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
4769 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004770 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004771 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
4772 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004773 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004774 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
4775 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004776 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
4777 }
4778
4779 // C++ [over.built]p3:
4780 //
4781 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
4782 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
4783 // functions of the form
4784 //
4785 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
4786 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
4787 //
4788 // C++ [over.built]p4:
4789 //
4790 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
4791 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
4792 // candidate operator functions of the form
4793 //
4794 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
4795 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
4796 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004797 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
4798 return;
4799
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004800 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
4801 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
4802 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004803 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004804 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
4805 }
4806 }
4807
4808 // C++ [over.built]p5:
4809 //
4810 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
4811 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
4812 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
4813 //
4814 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
4815 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
4816 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
4817 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
4818 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
4819 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4820 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
4821 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
4822 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4823 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
4824 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
4825 continue;
4826
4827 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
4828 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
4829 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
4830 }
4831 }
4832
4833 // C++ [over.built]p6:
4834 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
4835 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4836 //
4837 // T& operator*(T*);
4838 //
4839 // C++ [over.built]p7:
4840 // For every function type T, there exist candidate operator
4841 // functions of the form
4842 // T& operator*(T*);
4843 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
4844 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4845 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
4846 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
4847 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4848 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
4849 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
4850 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
4851 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4852 }
4853 }
4854
4855 // C++ [over.built]p9:
4856 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
4857 // operator functions of the form
4858 //
4859 // T operator+(T);
4860 // T operator-(T);
4861 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004862 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
4863 return;
4864
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004865 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
4866 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004867 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004868 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4869 }
4870
4871 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
4872 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4873 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
4874 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
4875 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
4876 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
4877 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4878 }
4879 }
4880
4881 // C++ [over.built]p8:
4882 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
4883 // the form
4884 //
4885 // T* operator+(T*);
4886 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
4887 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4888 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
4889 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
4890 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4891 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
4892 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4893 }
4894 }
4895
4896 // C++ [over.built]p10:
4897 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
4898 // operator functions of the form
4899 //
4900 // T operator~(T);
4901 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004902 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
4903 return;
4904
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004905 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
4906 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004907 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004908 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4909 }
4910
4911 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
4912 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4913 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
4914 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
4915 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
4916 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
4917 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4918 }
4919 }
4920
4921 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
4922 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
4923 // functions of the form
4924 //
4925 // bool operator==(T,T);
4926 // bool operator!=(T,T);
4927 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
4928 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
4929 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
4930
4931 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4932 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4933 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
4934 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
4935 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
4936 ++MemPtr) {
4937 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
4938 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
4939 continue;
4940
4941 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
4942 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
4943 CandidateSet);
4944 }
4945 }
4946 }
4947
4948 // C++ [over.built]p15:
4949 //
4950 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist
4951 // candidate operator functions of the form
4952 //
4953 // bool operator<(T, T);
4954 // bool operator>(T, T);
4955 // bool operator<=(T, T);
4956 // bool operator>=(T, T);
4957 // bool operator==(T, T);
4958 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00004959 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
4960 // C++ [over.built]p1:
4961 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
4962 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
4963 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
4964 // functions.
4965 //
4966 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
4967 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
4968 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
4969 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
4970 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
4971 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
4972 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
4973 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
4974 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
4975
4976 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4977 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
4978 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
4979 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
4980 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
4981 C != CEnd; ++C) {
4982 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
4983 continue;
4984
4985 QualType FirstParamType =
4986 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
4987 QualType SecondParamType =
4988 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
4989
4990 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
4991 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
4992 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
4993 continue;
4994
4995 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
4996 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
4997 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
4998 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
4999 }
5000 }
5001 }
5002
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005003 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5004 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5005
5006 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5007 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5008 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5009 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5010 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5011 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5012 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5013 continue;
5014
5015 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5016 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5017 CandidateSet);
5018 }
5019 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5020 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5021 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5022 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5023 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5024
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005025 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5026 // candidate exists.
5027 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5028 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5029 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005030 continue;
5031
5032 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005033 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5034 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005035 }
5036 }
5037 }
5038
5039 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5040 //
5041 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5042 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5043 //
5044 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5045 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
5046 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5047 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5048 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
5049 //
5050 // C++ [over.built]p14:
5051 //
5052 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5053 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5054 //
5055 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5056 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5057 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5058 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5059
5060 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5061 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5062 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5063 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5064 };
5065 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5066 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5067 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5068 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5069 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5070 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5071 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5072 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5073 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5074 CandidateSet);
5075 }
5076 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
5077 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5078 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5079 continue;
5080
5081 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5082 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
5083 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5084 }
5085 }
5086 }
5087 }
5088
5089 // C++ [over.built]p12:
5090 //
5091 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
5092 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5093 //
5094 // LR operator*(L, R);
5095 // LR operator/(L, R);
5096 // LR operator+(L, R);
5097 // LR operator-(L, R);
5098 // bool operator<(L, R);
5099 // bool operator>(L, R);
5100 // bool operator<=(L, R);
5101 // bool operator>=(L, R);
5102 // bool operator==(L, R);
5103 // bool operator!=(L, R);
5104 //
5105 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5106 // between types L and R.
5107 //
5108 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5109 //
5110 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
5111 // candidate operator functions of the form
5112 //
5113 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
5114 //
5115 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5116 // between types L and R.
5117 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
5118 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005119 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5120 return;
5121
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005122 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5123 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
5124 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5125 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005126 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5127 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005128 QualType Result =
5129 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005130 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005131 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5132 }
5133 }
5134
5135 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
5136 // conditional operator for vector types.
5137 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5138 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5139 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5140 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5141 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5142 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5143 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5144 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5145 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
5146 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
5147 if (!isComparison) {
5148 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
5149 Result = *Vec1;
5150 else
5151 Result = *Vec2;
5152 }
5153
5154 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5155 }
5156 }
5157 }
5158
5159 // C++ [over.built]p17:
5160 //
5161 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5162 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5163 //
5164 // LR operator%(L, R);
5165 // LR operator&(L, R);
5166 // LR operator^(L, R);
5167 // LR operator|(L, R);
5168 // L operator<<(L, R);
5169 // L operator>>(L, R);
5170 //
5171 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5172 // between types L and R.
5173 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005174 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5175 return;
5176
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005177 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5178 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5179 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5180 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005181 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5182 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005183 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5184 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005185 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005186 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5187 }
5188 }
5189 }
5190
5191 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5192 //
5193 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5194 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5195 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5196 //
5197 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5198 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5199 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5200 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5201
5202 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5203 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5204 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5205 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5206 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5207 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5208 continue;
5209
5210 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5211 CandidateSet);
5212 }
5213
5214 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5215 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5216 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5217 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5218 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5219 continue;
5220
5221 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5222 CandidateSet);
5223 }
5224 }
5225 }
5226
5227 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5228 //
5229 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5230 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5231 // of the form
5232 //
5233 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5234 //
5235 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5236 //
5237 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5238 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5239 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5240 //
5241 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5242 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5243 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5244 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5245 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5246
5247 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5248 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5249 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5250 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5251 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5252 if (isEqualOp)
5253 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
5254
5255 // non-volatile version
5256 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5257 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5258 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5259 };
5260 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5261 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5262
5263 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5264 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5265 // volatile version
5266 ParamTypes[0] =
5267 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5268 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5269 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5270 }
5271 }
5272
5273 if (isEqualOp) {
5274 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5275 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5276 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5277 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5278 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5279 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5280 continue;
5281
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005282 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5283 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5284 *Ptr,
5285 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005286
5287 // non-volatile version
5288 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5289 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5290
5291 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5292 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5293 // volatile version
5294 ParamTypes[0] =
5295 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005296 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5297 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005298 }
5299 }
5300 }
5301 }
5302
5303 // C++ [over.built]p18:
5304 //
5305 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
5306 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
5307 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
5308 // the form
5309 //
5310 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
5311 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
5312 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
5313 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
5314 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
5315 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005316 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5317 return;
5318
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005319 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
5320 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5321 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
5322 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005323 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005324
5325 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5326 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005327 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005328 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5329 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5330
5331 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5332 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5333 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005334 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005335 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005336 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5337 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005338 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5339 }
5340 }
5341 }
5342
5343 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
5344 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5345 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5346 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5347 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5348 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5349 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5350 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5351 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5352 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5353 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
5354 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5355 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
5356 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5357 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5358
5359 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5360 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5361 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
5362 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005363 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5364 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005365 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5366 }
5367 }
5368 }
5369 }
5370
5371 // C++ [over.built]p22:
5372 //
5373 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
5374 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
5375 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5376 //
5377 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
5378 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
5379 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
5380 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
5381 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
5382 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
5383 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005384 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5385 return;
5386
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005387 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
5388 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5389 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
5390 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005391 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005392
5393 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5394 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005395 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005396 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5397 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5398 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005399 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005400 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
5401 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
5402 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5403 CandidateSet);
5404 }
5405 }
5406 }
5407 }
5408
5409 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
5410 //
5411 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
5412 //
5413 // bool operator!(bool);
5414 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
5415 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
5416 void addExclaimOverload() {
5417 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
5418 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
5419 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5420 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
5421 }
5422 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
5423 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
5424 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5425 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5426 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
5427 }
5428
5429 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5430 //
5431 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
5432 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5433 //
5434 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5435 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
5436 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5437 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
5438 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5439 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
5440 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5441 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5442 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5443 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5444 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
5445 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5446 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5447
5448 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
5449 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5450 }
5451
5452 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5453 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5454 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5455 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5456 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
5457 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5458 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5459
5460 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
5461 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5462 }
5463 }
5464
5465 // C++ [over.built]p11:
5466 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
5467 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
5468 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
5469 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5470 //
5471 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
5472 //
5473 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
5474 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
5475 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5476 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5477 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5478 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5479 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
5480 QualType C1;
5481 QualifierCollector Q1;
5482 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
5483 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
5484 continue;
5485 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
5486 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
5487 // volatile/restrict type.
5488 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
5489 continue;
5490 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
5491 continue;
5492 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5493 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
5494 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
5495 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5496 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
5497 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
5498 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
5499 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
5500 break;
5501 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
5502 // build CV12 T&
5503 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
5504 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
5505 T.isVolatileQualified())
5506 continue;
5507 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
5508 T.isRestrictQualified())
5509 continue;
5510 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
5511 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5512 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5513 }
5514 }
5515 }
5516
5517 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
5518 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
5519 // therefore added as binary.
5520 //
5521 // C++ [over.built]p25:
5522 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
5523 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5524 //
5525 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
5526 //
5527 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
5528 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5529 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5530
5531 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5532 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5533 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5534 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5535 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5536 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5537 continue;
5538
5539 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5540 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5541 }
5542
5543 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5544 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5545 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5546 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5547 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5548 continue;
5549
5550 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5551 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5552 }
5553
5554 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
5555 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5556 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5557 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5558 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5559 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
5560 continue;
5561
5562 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5563 continue;
5564
5565 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
5566 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5567 }
5568 }
5569 }
5570 }
5571};
5572
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005573} // end anonymous namespace
5574
5575/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
5576/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
5577/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
5578/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
5579/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
5580void
5581Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5582 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5583 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5584 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005585 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
5586 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005587 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
5588 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005589 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
5590 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00005591 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5592 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005593
5594 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
5595 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005596 llvm::SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
5597 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5598 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
5599 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
5600 OpLoc,
5601 true,
5602 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
5603 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
5604 Op == OO_PipePipe),
5605 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005606 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
5607 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
5608 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
5609 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
5610 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005611 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005612
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005613 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
5614 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
5615 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType)
5616 return;
5617
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005618 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
5619 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
5620 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005621 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005622 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
5623
5624 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005625 switch (Op) {
5626 case OO_None:
5627 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
5628 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
5629 break;
5630
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005631 case OO_New:
5632 case OO_Delete:
5633 case OO_Array_New:
5634 case OO_Array_Delete:
5635 case OO_Call:
5636 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
5637 break;
5638
5639 case OO_Comma:
5640 case OO_Arrow:
5641 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5642 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
5643 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005644 break;
5645
5646 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00005647 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005648 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00005649 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005650
5651 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00005652 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005653 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00005654 } else {
5655 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
5656 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
5657 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005658 break;
5659
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005660 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005661 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005662 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
5663 else
5664 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
5665 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005666
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005667 case OO_Slash:
5668 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00005669 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005670
5671 case OO_PlusPlus:
5672 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005673 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
5674 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005675 break;
5676
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005677 case OO_EqualEqual:
5678 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005679 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00005680 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00005681
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005682 case OO_Less:
5683 case OO_Greater:
5684 case OO_LessEqual:
5685 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005686 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00005687 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
5688 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005689
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005690 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005691 case OO_Caret:
5692 case OO_Pipe:
5693 case OO_LessLess:
5694 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005695 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005696 break;
5697
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005698 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
5699 if (NumArgs == 1)
5700 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5701 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
5702 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
5703 break;
5704
5705 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
5706 break;
5707
5708 case OO_Tilde:
5709 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
5710 break;
5711
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005712 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005713 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005714 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005715
5716 case OO_PlusEqual:
5717 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005718 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005719 // Fall through.
5720
5721 case OO_StarEqual:
5722 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005723 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005724 break;
5725
5726 case OO_PercentEqual:
5727 case OO_LessLessEqual:
5728 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
5729 case OO_AmpEqual:
5730 case OO_CaretEqual:
5731 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005732 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005733 break;
5734
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005735 case OO_Exclaim:
5736 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005737 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005738
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005739 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005740 case OO_PipePipe:
5741 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005742 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005743
5744 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005745 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005746 break;
5747
5748 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005749 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005750 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005751
5752 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005753 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00005754 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
5755 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005756 }
5757}
5758
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005759/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
5760/// to the set of overloading candidates.
5761///
5762/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
5763/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
5764/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
5765/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005766void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005767Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005768 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005769 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005770 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005771 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5772 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005773 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005774
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00005775 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
5776 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
5777 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
5778 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
5779 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
5780 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
5781
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005782 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005783 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005784
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005785 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005786 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
5787 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5788 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005789 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005790 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005791 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005792 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005793 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005794
5795 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
5796 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005797 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005798 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005799 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005800 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005801 continue;
5802
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005803 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00005804 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005805 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005806 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005807 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00005808 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005809 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005810}
5811
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005812/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
5813/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005814bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005815isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00005816 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
5817 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005818 SourceLocation Loc,
5819 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005820 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
5821 // functions.
5822 if (!Cand2.Viable)
5823 return Cand1.Viable;
5824 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
5825 return false;
5826
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005827 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
5828 //
5829 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
5830 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
5831 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
5832 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
5833 unsigned StartArg = 0;
5834 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
5835 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005836
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005837 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005838 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
5839 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005840 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005841 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
5842 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
5843 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005844 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005845 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
5846 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005847 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
5848 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
5849 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
5850 HasBetterConversion = true;
5851 break;
5852
5853 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
5854 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
5855 return false;
5856
5857 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
5858 // Do nothing.
5859 break;
5860 }
5861 }
5862
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005863 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005864 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005865 if (HasBetterConversion)
5866 return true;
5867
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005868 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005869 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00005870 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005871 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
5872 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005873
5874 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
5875 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
5876 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005877 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00005878 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5879 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005880 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005881 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
5882 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
5883 Loc,
Douglas Gregor6010da02009-09-14 23:02:14 +00005884 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
5885 : TPOC_Call))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005886 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005887
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005888 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
5889 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
5890 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
5891 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
5892 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
5893 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005894 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005895 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005896 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005897 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
5898 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005899 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
5900 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
5901 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
5902 return true;
5903
5904 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
5905 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
5906 return false;
5907
5908 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
5909 // Do nothing
5910 break;
5911 }
5912 }
5913
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005914 return false;
5915}
5916
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005917/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005918/// within an overload candidate set.
5919///
5920/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
5921///
5922/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
5923/// which overload resolution occurs.
5924///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005925/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005926/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
5927///
5928/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005929OverloadingResult
5930OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00005931 iterator &Best,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005932 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005933 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005934 Best = end();
5935 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
5936 if (Cand->Viable)
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005937 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
5938 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005939 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005940 }
5941
5942 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005943 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005944 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
5945
5946 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
5947 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005948 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005949 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005950 Cand != Best &&
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005951 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
5952 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005953 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005954 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005955 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005956 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005957
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005958 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00005959 if (Best->Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005960 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005961 Best->Function->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00005962 return OR_Deleted;
5963
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005964 // C++ [basic.def.odr]p2:
5965 // An overloaded function is used if it is selected by overload resolution
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005966 // when referred to from a potentially-evaluated expression. [Note: this
5967 // covers calls to named functions (5.2.2), operator overloading
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005968 // (clause 13), user-defined conversions (12.3.2), allocation function for
5969 // placement new (5.3.4), as well as non-default initialization (8.5).
5970 if (Best->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005971 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Best->Function);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00005972
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005973 return OR_Success;
5974}
5975
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005976namespace {
5977
5978enum OverloadCandidateKind {
5979 oc_function,
5980 oc_method,
5981 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005982 oc_function_template,
5983 oc_method_template,
5984 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005985 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
5986 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005987 oc_implicit_copy_assignment
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005988};
5989
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005990OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
5991 FunctionDecl *Fn,
5992 std::string &Description) {
5993 bool isTemplate = false;
5994
5995 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
5996 isTemplate = true;
5997 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
5998 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
5999 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006000
6001 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006002 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006003 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006004
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006005 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor
6006 : oc_implicit_default_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006007 }
6008
6009 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6010 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6011 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006012 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006013 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006014
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00006015 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006016 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006017 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6018 }
6019
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006020 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006021}
6022
6023} // end anonymous namespace
6024
6025// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6026void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006027 std::string FnDesc;
6028 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6029 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6030 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006031}
6032
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006033/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
6034/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
6035/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006036void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
6037 Sema &S,
6038 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6039 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
6040 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
6041 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006042 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006043 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6044 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006045 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006046}
6047
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006048namespace {
6049
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006050void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
6051 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
6052 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006053 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
6054 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6055
6056 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
6057 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
6058 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006059 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006060 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006061 if (I == 0)
6062 isObjectArgument = true;
6063 else
6064 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006065 }
6066
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006067 std::string FnDesc;
6068 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
6069
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006070 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6071 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
6072 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006073
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006074 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006075 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006076 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
6077 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
6078 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006079 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006080
6081 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
6082 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6083 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6084 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
6085 return;
6086 }
6087
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006088 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6089 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006090 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6091 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6092 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6093 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6094 else {
6095 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6096 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6097 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6098 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6099 }
6100
6101 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6102 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6103 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6104 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6105 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6106 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6107 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6108
6109 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6110 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6111
6112 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6113 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6114 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6115 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6116 << FromTy
6117 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6118 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6119 return;
6120 }
6121
6122 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6123 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6124
6125 if (isObjectArgument) {
6126 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6127 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6128 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6129 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6130 } else {
6131 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6132 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6133 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6134 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6135 }
6136 return;
6137 }
6138
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006139 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6140 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6141 // the failure.
6142 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6143 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6144 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6145 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6146 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6147 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6148 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6149 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6150 return;
6151 }
6152
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006153 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006154 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006155 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6156 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6157 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6158 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6159 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6160 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6161 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
6162 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006163 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006164 }
6165 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6166 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6167 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6168 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6169 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6170 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6171 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6172 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6173 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006174 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6175 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6176 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6177 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6178 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6179 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6180 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6181 }
6182
6183 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006184 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006185 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006186 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6187 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006188 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006189 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
6190 return;
6191 }
6192
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006193 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006194 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv)
6195 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006196 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
John McCalla1709fd2010-01-14 00:56:20 +00006197 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006198}
6199
6200void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6201 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
6202 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
6203
6204 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6205 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6206
6207 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
6208
6209 // at least / at most / exactly
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006210 // FIXME: variadic templates "at most" should account for parameter packs
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006211 unsigned mode, modeCount;
6212 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006213 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
6214 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6215 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006216 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() || FnTy->isVariadic())
6217 mode = 0; // "at least"
6218 else
6219 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6220 modeCount = MinParams;
6221 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006222 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
6223 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6224 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006225 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
6226 mode = 1; // "at most"
6227 else
6228 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6229 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
6230 }
6231
6232 std::string Description;
6233 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
6234
6235 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006236 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
6237 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006238}
6239
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006240/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
6241void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6242 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6243 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
6244
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006245 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006246 NamedDecl *ParamD;
6247 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
6248 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
6249 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006250 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
6251 case Sema::TDK_Success:
6252 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
6253
6254 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006255 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
6256 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
6257 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6258 return;
6259 }
6260
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006261 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
6262 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
6263 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
6264
6265 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
6266
6267 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
6268 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006269 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006270 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006271 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006272 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
6273
6274 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
6275 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
6276 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
6277 // done on dependent types).
6278 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
6279
6280 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
6281 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
6282 return;
6283 }
6284
6285 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006286 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006287 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006288 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006289 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006290 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006291 which = 1;
6292 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006293 which = 2;
6294 }
6295
6296 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
6297 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
6298 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
6299 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
6300 return;
6301 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006302
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006303 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
6304 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
6305 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
6306 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
6307 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
6308 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6309 else {
6310 int index = 0;
6311 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
6312 index = TTP->getIndex();
6313 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
6314 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
6315 index = NTTP->getIndex();
6316 else
6317 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
6318 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
6319 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
6320 << (index + 1);
6321 }
6322 return;
6323
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006324 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
6325 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
6326 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
6327 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006328
6329 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
6330 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
6331 return;
6332
6333 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
6334 std::string ArgString;
6335 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
6336 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
6337 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6338 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
6339 *Args);
6340 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
6341 << ArgString;
6342 return;
6343 }
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006344
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006345 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
6346 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006347 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006348 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
6349 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
6350 return;
6351 }
6352}
6353
6354/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
6355/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
6356///
6357/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
6358/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
6359/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
6360/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
6361/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
6362/// overload.
6363///
6364/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
6365/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
6366/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006367void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6368 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006369 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6370
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006371 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006372 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>())) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006373 std::string FnDesc;
6374 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006375
6376 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006377 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006378 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006379 }
6380
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006381 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
6382 if (Cand->Viable) {
6383 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
6384 return;
6385 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006386
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006387 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
6388 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
6389 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
6390 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006391
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006392 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006393 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
6394
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006395 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
6396 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006397 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006398 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006399
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006400 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
6401 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
6402 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006403 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
6404 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
6405
6406 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
6407 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
6408 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
6409 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006410 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006411 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006412}
6413
6414void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6415 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
6416 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
6417 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
6418 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
6419 bool isLValueReference = false;
6420 bool isRValueReference = false;
6421 bool isPointer = false;
6422 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6423 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
6424 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6425 isLValueReference = true;
6426 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6427 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
6428 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6429 isRValueReference = true;
6430 }
6431 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6432 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6433 isPointer = true;
6434 }
6435 // Desugar down to a function type.
6436 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
6437 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
6438 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
6439 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
6440 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
6441
6442 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
6443 << FnType;
6444}
6445
6446void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
6447 const char *Opc,
6448 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6449 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6450 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
6451 std::string TypeStr("operator");
6452 TypeStr += Opc;
6453 TypeStr += "(";
6454 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
6455 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
6456 TypeStr += ")";
6457 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6458 } else {
6459 TypeStr += ", ";
6460 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
6461 TypeStr += ")";
6462 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6463 }
6464}
6465
6466void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6467 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6468 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
6469 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
6470 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006471 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
6472 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
6473
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006474 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006475 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006476 }
6477}
6478
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006479SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6480 if (Cand->Function)
6481 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006482 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006483 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
6484 return SourceLocation();
6485}
6486
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006487struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
6488 Sema &S;
6489 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006490
6491 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
6492 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006493 // Fast-path this check.
6494 if (L == R) return false;
6495
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006496 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006497 if (L->Viable) {
6498 if (!R->Viable) return true;
6499
6500 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
6501 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
6502 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006503 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
6504 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006505 } else if (R->Viable)
6506 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006507
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006508 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006509
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006510 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
6511 if (!L->Viable) {
6512 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
6513 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6514 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6515 return false;
6516 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6517 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6518 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006519
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006520 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
6521 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
6522 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
6523 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6524 return true;
6525
6526 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
6527 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
6528 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
6529
6530 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00006531 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
6532 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006533 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6534 L->Conversions[I],
6535 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006536 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6537 leftBetter++;
6538 break;
6539
6540 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6541 leftBetter--;
6542 break;
6543
6544 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6545 break;
6546 }
6547 }
6548 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
6549 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
6550
6551 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6552 return false;
6553
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006554 // TODO: others?
6555 }
6556
6557 // Sort everything else by location.
6558 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
6559 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
6560
6561 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
6562 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
6563 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
6564
6565 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006566 }
6567};
6568
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006569/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
6570/// computes up to the first
6571void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6572 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6573 assert(!Cand->Viable);
6574
6575 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
6576 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
6577
6578 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006579 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006580 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
6581 while (true) {
6582 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
6583 ConvIdx++;
6584 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad())
6585 break;
6586 }
6587
6588 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
6589 return;
6590
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006591 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
6592 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
6593
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00006594 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006595 // operation somehow.
6596 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006597
6598 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
6599 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
6600
6601 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
6602 QualType ConvType
6603 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6604 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
6605 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
6606 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6607 ArgIdx--;
6608 } else if (Cand->Function) {
6609 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6610 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
6611 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
6612 ArgIdx--;
6613 } else {
6614 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
6615 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
6616 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
6617 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006618 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
6619 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
6620 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006621 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006622 return;
6623 }
6624
6625 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
6626 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
6627 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
6628 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto)
6629 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006630 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
6631 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006632 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006633 else
6634 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6635 }
6636}
6637
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006638} // end anonymous namespace
6639
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006640/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
6641/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006642/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006643void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
6644 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
6645 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6646 const char *Opc,
6647 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006648 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
6649 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
6650 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006651 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
6652 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006653 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006654 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006655 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006656 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006657 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
6658 Cands.push_back(Cand);
6659 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
6660 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006661 }
6662 }
6663
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006664 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006665 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006666
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006667 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006668
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006669 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006670 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006671 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006672 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6673 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00006674
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006675 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
6676 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
6677 // candidate list.
6678 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
6679 break;
6680 }
6681 ++CandsShown;
6682
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006683 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006684 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006685 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006686 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006687 else {
6688 assert(Cand->Viable &&
6689 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006690 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
6691 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
6692 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
6693 //
6694 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
6695 // different ambiguities, though.
6696 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006697 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006698 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
6699 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006700
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006701 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006702 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006703 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006704 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006705
6706 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006707 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006708}
6709
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006710static bool CheckUnresolvedAccess(Sema &S, OverloadExpr *E, DeclAccessPair D) {
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006711 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E))
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006712 return S.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E), D);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006713
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006714 return S.CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E), D);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006715}
6716
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006717/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
6718/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
6719/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
6720/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
6721///
6722/// @code
6723/// int f(double);
6724/// int f(int);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006725///
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006726/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
6727/// @endcode
6728///
6729/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
6730/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
6731/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
6732FunctionDecl *
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006733Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006734 bool Complain,
6735 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006736 QualType FunctionType = ToType;
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006737 bool IsMember = false;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006738 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006739 FunctionType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006740 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Daniel Dunbarb566c6c2009-02-26 19:13:44 +00006741 FunctionType = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006742 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006743 ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006744 FunctionType = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6745 IsMember = true;
6746 }
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006747
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006748 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6749 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
6750 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006751 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6752 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
6753 // operator.
John McCall7d460512010-08-24 23:26:21 +00006754 // However, remember whether the expression has member-pointer form:
6755 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p4:
6756 // A pointer to member is only formed when an explicit & is used
6757 // and its operand is a qualified-id not enclosed in
6758 // parentheses.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006759 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(From);
6760 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
John McCall7d460512010-08-24 23:26:21 +00006761
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006762 // We expect a pointer or reference to function, or a function pointer.
6763 FunctionType = Context.getCanonicalType(FunctionType).getUnqualifiedType();
6764 if (!FunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
6765 if (Complain)
6766 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
6767 << OvlExpr->getName() << ToType;
6768
6769 return 0;
6770 }
6771
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00006772 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
John McCall7d460512010-08-24 23:26:21 +00006773 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006774 if (IsMember && !Ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer) {
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00006775 if (!Complain) return 0;
6776
6777 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
6778 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
6779 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
6780 Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
6781 << ToType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
6782 return 0;
6783 }
6784
6785 TemplateArgumentListInfo ETABuffer, *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
6786 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
6787 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ETABuffer);
6788 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &ETABuffer;
6789 }
6790
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006791 assert(From->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006792
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006793 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
6794 // whose type matches exactly.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006795 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
Douglas Gregorb242683d2010-04-01 18:32:35 +00006796 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> NonMatches;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006797
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006798 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction = false;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006799 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6800 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006801 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
6802 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
6803
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006804 // C++ [over.over]p3:
6805 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
Sebastian Redl16d307d2009-02-05 12:33:33 +00006806 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
6807 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006808 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
6809 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006810
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006811 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006812 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006813 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006814 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006815 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006816 // static when converting to member pointer.
6817 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember)
6818 continue;
6819 } else if (IsMember)
6820 continue;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006821
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006822 // C++ [over.over]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006823 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
6824 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
6825 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
6826 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006827 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006828 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006829 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006830 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006831 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006832 FunctionType, Specialization, Info)) {
6833 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
6834 (void)Result;
6835 } else {
Douglas Gregor4ed49f32010-09-29 21:14:36 +00006836 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
6837 // This function template specicalization works.
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006838 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006839 assert(FunctionType
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006840 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006841 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(), Specialization));
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006842 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006843
6844 continue;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006845 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006846
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006847 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006848 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
6849 // when converting to member pointer.
6850 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember)
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006851 continue;
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00006852
6853 // If we have explicit template arguments, skip non-templates.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006854 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00006855 continue;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006856 } else if (IsMember)
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006857 continue;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006858
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006859 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00006860 QualType ResultTy;
6861 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FunctionType, FunDecl->getType()) ||
6862 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), FunctionType,
6863 ResultTy)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006864 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(),
6865 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006866 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
6867 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006868 }
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006869 }
6870
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006871 // If there were 0 or 1 matches, we're done.
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006872 if (Matches.empty()) {
6873 if (Complain) {
6874 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
6875 << OvlExpr->getName() << FunctionType;
6876 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6877 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6878 I != E; ++I)
6879 if (FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
6880 NoteOverloadCandidate(F);
6881 }
6882
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006883 return 0;
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006884 } else if (Matches.size() == 1) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006885 FunctionDecl *Result = Matches[0].second;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006886 FoundResult = Matches[0].first;
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006887 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Result);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006888 if (Complain) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006889 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(OvlExpr, Matches[0].first);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006890 }
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006891 return Result;
6892 }
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006893
6894 // C++ [over.over]p4:
6895 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006896 if (!FoundNonTemplateFunction) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006897 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
6898 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
6899 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
6900 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
6901 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
6902
6903 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
6904 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
6905 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
6906 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006907
6908 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
6909 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
6910 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006911
6912 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006913 getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006914 TPOC_Other, From->getLocStart(),
6915 PDiag(),
6916 PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006917 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006918 PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6919 << (unsigned) oc_function_template);
Douglas Gregorbdd7b232010-09-12 08:16:09 +00006920 if (Result == MatchesCopy.end())
6921 return 0;
6922
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006923 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), *Result);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006924 FoundResult = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006925 if (Complain)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006926 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, FoundResult);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006927 return cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006928 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006929
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006930 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
6931 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006932 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006933 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006934 ++I;
6935 else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006936 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
6937 Matches.set_size(N);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006938 }
6939 }
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006940
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006941 // [...] After such eliminations, if any, there shall remain exactly one
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006942 // selected function.
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006943 if (Matches.size() == 1) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006944 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Matches[0].second);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006945 FoundResult = Matches[0].first;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006946 if (Complain)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006947 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, Matches[0].first);
6948 return cast<FunctionDecl>(Matches[0].second);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006949 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006950
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006951 // FIXME: We should probably return the same thing that BestViableFunction
6952 // returns (even if we issue the diagnostics here).
Douglas Gregore81f58e2010-11-08 03:40:48 +00006953 if (Complain) {
6954 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
6955 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName();
6956 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
6957 NoteOverloadCandidate(Matches[I].second);
6958 }
6959
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006960 return 0;
6961}
6962
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006963/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
6964/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
6965///
6966/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
6967/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
6968/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
6969/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
6970FunctionDecl *Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Expr *From) {
6971 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6972 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
6973 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006974 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6975 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
6976 // operator.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006977
6978 if (From->getType() != Context.OverloadTy)
6979 return 0;
6980
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006981 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = OverloadExpr::find(From).Expression;
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006982
6983 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006984 if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006985 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006986
6987 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
6988 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006989
6990 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
6991 // whose type matches exactly.
6992 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006993 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6994 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006995 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
6996 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
6997 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
6998 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
6999 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
7000 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00007001 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7002 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007003
7004 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7005 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7006 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7007 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7008 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7009 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007010 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007011 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007012 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7013 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7014 Specialization, Info)) {
7015 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7016 (void)Result;
7017 continue;
7018 }
7019
7020 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
7021 if (Matched)
7022 return 0;
7023
7024 Matched = Specialization;
7025 }
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00007026
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007027 return Matched;
7028}
7029
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007030/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
7031static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007032 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007033 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007034 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7035 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7036 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007037 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007038 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
7039 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
7040
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007041 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007042 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007043 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00007044 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007045 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007046 }
7047
7048 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
7049 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007050 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
7051 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007052 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007053 return;
7054 }
7055
7056 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
7057
7058 // do nothing?
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007059}
7060
7061/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
7062/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007063void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007064 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7065 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7066 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007067
7068#ifndef NDEBUG
7069 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
7070 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007071 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007072 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
7073 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
7074 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
7075 //
7076 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
7077 //
7078 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007079 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007080 //
7081 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
7082 // template
7083 //
7084 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007085
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007086 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7087 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7088 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7089 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
7090 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
7091 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
7092 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007093 }
7094 }
7095#endif
7096
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007097 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
7098 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7099 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7100 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7101 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7102 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7103 }
7104
7105 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7106 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007107 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007108 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007109 PartialOverloading);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007110
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007111 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007112 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
7113 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007114 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007115 CandidateSet,
7116 PartialOverloading);
7117}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007118
7119/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
7120///
7121/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007122static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007123BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007124 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
7125 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7126 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007127 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007128
7129 CXXScopeSpec SS;
7130 if (ULE->getQualifier()) {
7131 SS.setScopeRep(ULE->getQualifier());
7132 SS.setRange(ULE->getQualifierRange());
7133 }
7134
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007135 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7136 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7137 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7138 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7139 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7140 }
7141
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007142 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
7143 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00007144 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007145 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007146
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007147 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
7148
7149 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
7150 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007151 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007152 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007153 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
7154 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007155 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7156 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
7157 else
7158 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
7159
7160 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007161 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007162
7163 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
7164 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never
7165 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007166 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007167 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007168}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00007169
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007170/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007171/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
7172/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
7173/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
7174/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00007175/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007176/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007177ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007178Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007179 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7180 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007181 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
7182#ifndef NDEBUG
7183 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7184 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
7185 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
7186
7187 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
7188 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
7189 FunctionDecl *F;
7190 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
7191 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
7192 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
7193 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
7194
7195 // We don't perform ADL in C.
7196 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
7197 }
7198#endif
7199
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007200 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00007201
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007202 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
7203 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
7204 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007205
7206 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
7207 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just
7208 // bailout out if it fails.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007209 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007210 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007211 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007212
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007213 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007214 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007215 case OR_Success: {
7216 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007217 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007218 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
7219 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007220 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007221 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
7222 RParenLoc);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007223 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007224
7225 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00007226 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007227 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007228 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007229 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007230 break;
7231
7232 case OR_Ambiguous:
7233 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007234 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007235 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007236 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007237
7238 case OR_Deleted:
7239 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
7240 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007241 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007242 << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007243 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007244 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007245 }
7246
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007247 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007248 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007249}
7250
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007251static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00007252 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
7253 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
7254}
7255
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007256/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7257/// operator.
7258///
7259/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
7260///
7261/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7262/// operator.
7263///
7264/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7265/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7266/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7267/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7268/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7269/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
7270///
7271/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007272ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007273Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
7274 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007275 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007276 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007277
7278 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7279 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
7280 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007281 // TODO: provide better source location info.
7282 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007283
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007284 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7285 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
7286
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007287 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
7288 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007289
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007290 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
7291 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
7292 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007293 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007294 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00007295 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
7296 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007297 NumArgs = 2;
7298 }
7299
7300 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007301 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007302 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007303 Opc,
7304 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007305 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007306 OpLoc));
7307
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007308 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007309 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00007310 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007311 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007312 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
7313 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007314 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
7315 &Args[0], NumArgs,
7316 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007317 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007318 OpLoc));
7319 }
7320
7321 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007322 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007323
7324 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007325 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007326
7327 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7328 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
7329
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007330 // Add candidates from ADL.
7331 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00007332 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007333 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7334 CandidateSet);
7335
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007336 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007337 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007338
7339 // Perform overload resolution.
7340 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007341 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007342 case OR_Success: {
7343 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7344 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007345
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007346 if (FnDecl) {
7347 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7348 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007349
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007350 // Convert the arguments.
7351 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007352 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007353
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007354 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7355 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007356 return ExprError();
7357 } else {
7358 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007359 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007360 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007361 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00007362 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007363 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007364 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007365 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007366 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007367 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007368 }
7369
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007370 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
7371
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007372 // Determine the result type.
7373 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7374 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7375 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007376
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007377 // Build the actual expression node.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007378 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007379
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00007380 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007381 CallExpr *TheCall =
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00007382 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007383 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007384
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007385 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00007386 FnDecl))
7387 return ExprError();
7388
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007389 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007390 } else {
7391 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7392 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7393 // operator node.
7394 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007395 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing))
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007396 return ExprError();
7397
7398 break;
7399 }
7400 }
7401
7402 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
7403 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
7404 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
7405 break;
7406
7407 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007408 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007409 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007410 << Input->getType()
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007411 << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007412 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
7413 Args, NumArgs,
7414 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007415 return ExprError();
7416
7417 case OR_Deleted:
7418 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7419 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7420 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
7421 << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007422 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007423 return ExprError();
7424 }
7425
7426 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
7427 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
7428 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007429 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007430}
7431
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007432/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7433/// operator.
7434///
7435/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
7436///
7437/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7438/// operator.
7439///
7440/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7441/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7442/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7443/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7444/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7445/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
7446///
7447/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
7448/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007449ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007450Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007451 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007452 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007453 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007454 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007455 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007456
7457 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
7458 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7459 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
7460
7461 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
7462 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007463 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007464 if (Fns.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007465 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
7466 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007467 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007468 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007469 Context.DependentTy,
7470 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
7471 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007472
7473 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
7474 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007475 VK_LValue,
7476 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007477 Context.DependentTy,
7478 Context.DependentTy,
7479 OpLoc));
7480 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007481
7482 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007483 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007484 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
7485 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007486 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00007487 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 0, SourceRange(),
7488 OpNameInfo, /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007489 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007490 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007491 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007492 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007493 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007494 OpLoc));
7495 }
7496
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007497 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
7498 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7499 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
7500
7501 // The LHS is more complicated.
7502 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7503
7504 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
7505 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
7506 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
7507 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
7508
7509 // Is the property "logically" settable?
7510 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
7511 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
7512
7513 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
7514 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
7515 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
7516 // load and hope.
7517 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
7518 // we really should use the primitive.
7519 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
7520 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
7521 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
7522 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
7523 if (Settable)
7524 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
7525 }
7526
7527 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
7528 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007529
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00007530 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
7531 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
7532 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
7533 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
7534 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
7535 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007536 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007537 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007538
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007539 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
7540 // create a built-in binary operator.
7541 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
7542 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
7543
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007544 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007545 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007546
7547 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007548 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007549
7550 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7551 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7552
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007553 // Add candidates from ADL.
7554 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
7555 Args, 2,
7556 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7557 CandidateSet);
7558
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007559 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007560 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007561
7562 // Perform overload resolution.
7563 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007564 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007565 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007566 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7567 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
7568
7569 if (FnDecl) {
7570 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7571 // operator.
7572
7573 // Convert the arguments.
7574 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007575 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007576 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007577
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007578 ExprResult Arg1 =
7579 PerformCopyInitialization(
7580 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
7581 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
7582 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007583 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007584 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007585
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007586 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007587 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007588 return ExprError();
7589
7590 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007591 } else {
7592 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007593 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
7594 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
7595 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
7596 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007597 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007598 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007599
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007600 ExprResult Arg1 =
7601 PerformCopyInitialization(
7602 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
7603 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
7604 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007605 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
7606 return ExprError();
7607 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
7608 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007609 }
7610
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007611 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
7612
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007613 // Determine the result type.
7614 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7615 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7616 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007617
7618 // Build the actual expression node.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007619 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007620
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007621 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
7622 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007623 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00007624
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007625 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00007626 FnDecl))
7627 return ExprError();
7628
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007629 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007630 } else {
7631 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7632 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7633 // operator node.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007634 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007635 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) ||
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007636 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007637 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing))
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007638 return ExprError();
7639
7640 break;
7641 }
7642 }
7643
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007644 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
7645 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
7646 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
7647 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
7648 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007649 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007650 break;
7651
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007652 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
7653 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
7654 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007655 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007656 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007657 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00007658 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
7659 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007660 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007661 } else {
7662 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
7663 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
7664 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00007665 }
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007666 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
7667 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
7668 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007669 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
7670 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007671 return move(Result);
7672 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007673
7674 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007675 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007676 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007677 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007678 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007679 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
7680 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007681 return ExprError();
7682
7683 case OR_Deleted:
7684 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7685 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7686 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007687 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007688 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007689 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007690 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007691
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007692 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007693 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007694}
7695
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007696ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007697Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
7698 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007699 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
7700 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007701 DeclarationName OpName =
7702 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
7703
7704 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
7705 // expression.
7706 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
7707
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007708 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007709 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
7710 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
7711 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007712 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00007713 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007714 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007715 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
7716 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
7717 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00007718 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007719
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007720 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
7721 Args, 2,
7722 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007723 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007724 RLoc));
7725 }
7726
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007727 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7728 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
7729 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7730 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
7731
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007732 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007733 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007734
7735 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
7736
7737 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7738 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7739
7740 // Add builtin operator candidates.
7741 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7742
7743 // Perform overload resolution.
7744 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007745 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007746 case OR_Success: {
7747 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7748 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
7749
7750 if (FnDecl) {
7751 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7752 // operator.
7753
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007754 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007755 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007756
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007757 // Convert the arguments.
7758 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007759 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007760 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007761 return ExprError();
7762
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00007763 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007764 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00007765 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007766 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00007767 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
7768 SourceLocation(),
7769 Owned(Args[1]));
7770 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
7771 return ExprError();
7772
7773 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
7774
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007775 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007776 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7777 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7778 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007779
7780 // Build the actual expression node.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007781 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007782
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007783 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
7784 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
7785 FnExpr, Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007786 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007787
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007788 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007789 FnDecl))
7790 return ExprError();
7791
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007792 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007793 } else {
7794 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7795 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7796 // operator node.
7797 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007798 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) ||
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007799 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007800 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007801 return ExprError();
7802
7803 break;
7804 }
7805 }
7806
7807 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00007808 if (CandidateSet.empty())
7809 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
7810 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
7811 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
7812 else
7813 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
7814 << Args[0]->getType()
7815 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007816 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
7817 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00007818 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007819 }
7820
7821 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007822 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
7823 << "[]"
7824 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
7825 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007826 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
7827 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007828 return ExprError();
7829
7830 case OR_Deleted:
7831 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7832 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
7833 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007834 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
7835 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007836 return ExprError();
7837 }
7838
7839 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007840 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007841}
7842
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007843/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
7844/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
7845/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
7846/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
7847/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
7848/// expression refers to a member function or an overloaded member
7849/// function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007850ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007851Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
7852 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007853 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007854 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
7855 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007856 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
7857
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007858 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007859 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00007860 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007861 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007862 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
7863 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007864 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007865 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007866 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007867 } else {
7868 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007869 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
7870
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007871 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007872
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007873 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007874 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007875
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007876 // FIXME: avoid copy.
7877 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
7878 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7879 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
7880 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
7881 }
7882
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007883 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
7884 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7885
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007886 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
7887 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
7888 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
7889 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
7890
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007891 if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00007892 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
7893 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007894 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00007895 continue;
7896
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007897 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00007898 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007899 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007900 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007901 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007902 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007903 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00007904 CandidateSet,
7905 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007906 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00007907 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007908
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007909 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
7910
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007911 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007912 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007913 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007914 case OR_Success:
7915 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007916 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007917 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007918 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007919 break;
7920
7921 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007922 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007923 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007924 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007925 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007926 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007927 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007928
7929 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007930 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007931 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007932 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007933 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007934 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007935
7936 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007937 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007938 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007939 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007940 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007941 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007942 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007943 }
7944
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007945 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007946
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007947 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
7948 // non-member call based on that function.
7949 if (Method->isStatic()) {
7950 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
7951 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
7952 }
7953
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007954 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007955 }
7956
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007957 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
7958 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
7959 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7960
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007961 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007962 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
7963 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007964 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007965
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00007966 // Check for a valid return type.
7967 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007968 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007969 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00007970
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007971 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007972 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
7973 // it was done at lookup.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007974 Expr *ObjectArg = MemExpr->getBase();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007975 if (!Method->isStatic() &&
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007976 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(ObjectArg, Qualifier,
7977 FoundDecl, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007978 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007979 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg);
7980
7981 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007982 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
7983 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007984 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007985 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007986 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007987
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007988 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007989 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00007990
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007991 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007992}
7993
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007994/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
7995/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
7996/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
7997/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007998ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007999Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Object,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00008000 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008001 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008002 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008003 if (Object->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
8004 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object);
8005
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008006 assert(Object->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008007 const RecordType *Record = Object->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008008
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008009 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
8010 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00008011 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008012 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
8013 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
8014 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
8015 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008016 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00008017 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008018
8019 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008020 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008021 << Object->getSourceRange()))
8022 return true;
8023
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008024 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8025 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
8026 R.suppressDiagnostics();
8027
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008028 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008029 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008030 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object->getType(),
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00008031 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00008032 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008033 }
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008034
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008035 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
8036 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the
8037 // form
8038 //
8039 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
8040 //
8041 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
8042 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00008043 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
8044 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
8045 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
8046 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008047 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
8048 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
8049 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
8050 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
8051 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008052 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00008053 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008054 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008055 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008056 NamedDecl *D = *I;
8057 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
8058 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8059 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8060
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008061 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
8062 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008063 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008064 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008065
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008066 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008067
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008068 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
8069 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
8070 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8071 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8072 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008073
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008074 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008075 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008076 Object->getType(), Args, NumArgs,
8077 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008078 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008079
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008080 // Perform overload resolution.
8081 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008082 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object->getLocStart(),
8083 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008084 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008085 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
8086 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008087 break;
8088
8089 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008090 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8091 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8092 << Object->getType() << /*call*/ 1
8093 << Object->getSourceRange();
8094 else
8095 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8096 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
8097 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008098 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008099 break;
8100
8101 case OR_Ambiguous:
8102 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8103 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00008104 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008105 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008106 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008107
8108 case OR_Deleted:
8109 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8110 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
8111 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8112 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008113 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008114 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008115 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008116
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008117 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008118 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008119
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008120 if (Best->Function == 0) {
8121 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
8122 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008123 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008124 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
8125 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
8126
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008127 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008128 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008129
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008130 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
8131 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
8132 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00008133
8134 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008135 // and then call it.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008136 CXXMemberCallExpr *CE = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object, Best->FoundDecl,
8137 Conv);
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008138
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008139 return ActOnCallExpr(S, CE, LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008140 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008141 }
8142
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008143 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008144 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008145
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008146 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
8147 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
8148 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
8149 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008150 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8151 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008152
8153 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8154 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
8155
8156 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
8157 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
8158 // list).
8159 Expr **MethodArgs;
8160 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
8161 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8162 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
8163 } else {
8164 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
8165 }
8166 MethodArgs[0] = Object;
8167 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
8168 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008169
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008170 Expr *NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008171
8172 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
8173 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008174 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8175 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8176 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8177
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008178 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8179 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn,
8180 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008181 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008182 delete [] MethodArgs;
8183
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008184 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00008185 Method))
8186 return true;
8187
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008188 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
8189 // slots in the call for them.
8190 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00008191 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008192 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
8193 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8194
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008195 bool IsError = false;
8196
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008197 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008198 IsError |= PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object, /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008199 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008200 TheCall->setArg(0, Object);
8201
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008202
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008203 // Check the argument types.
8204 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008205 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008206 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008207 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008208
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008209 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008210
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008211 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008212 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008213 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008214 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008215 SourceLocation(), Arg);
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008216
8217 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
8218 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008219 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008220 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00008221 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
8222 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
8223 IsError = true;
8224 break;
8225 }
8226
8227 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008228 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008229
8230 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
8231 }
8232
8233 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
8234 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
8235 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
8236 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
8237 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00008238 IsError |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, VariadicMethod, 0);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008239 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
8240 }
8241 }
8242
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008243 if (IsError) return true;
8244
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008245 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00008246 return true;
8247
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +00008248 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008249}
8250
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008251/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008252/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008253/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008254ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008255Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008256 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
8257 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008258
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008259 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
8260 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
8261
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008262 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
8263
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008264 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
8265 //
8266 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
8267 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
8268 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
8269 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008270 DeclarationName OpName =
8271 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008272 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008273 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008274
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008275 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00008276 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
8277 << Base->getSourceRange()))
8278 return ExprError();
8279
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008280 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8281 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
8282 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00008283
8284 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008285 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008286 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), 0, 0, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008287 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008288 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008289
8290 // Perform overload resolution.
8291 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008292 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008293 case OR_Success:
8294 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
8295 break;
8296
8297 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
8298 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8299 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008300 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008301 else
8302 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008303 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008304 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008305 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008306
8307 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008308 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8309 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008310 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008311 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008312
8313 case OR_Deleted:
8314 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8315 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00008316 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008317 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008318 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008319 }
8320
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008321 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008322 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008323
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008324 // Convert the object parameter.
8325 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008326 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8327 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008328 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00008329
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008330 // Build the operator call.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008331 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008332
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008333 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8334 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8335 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008336 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8337 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008338 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008339
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008340 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008341 Method))
8342 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008343 return Owned(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008344}
8345
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008346/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
8347/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
8348/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
8349/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00008350/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00008351Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008352 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008353 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008354 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
8355 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008356 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008357 return PE;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008358
8359 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
8360 }
8361
8362 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008363 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
8364 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00008365 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008366 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00008367 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00008368 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008369 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008370 return ICE;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008371
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00008372 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
8373 ICE->getCastKind(),
8374 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00008375 ICE->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008376 }
8377
8378 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008379 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008380 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00008381 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8382 if (Method->isStatic()) {
8383 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
8384 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008385 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008386 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
8387 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
8388 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008389 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
8390 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008391 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008392 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008393
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008394 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
8395 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
8396 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
8397 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
8398
8399 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
8400 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
8401 // appropriate pointer to member type.
8402 QualType ClassType
8403 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
8404 QualType MemPtrType
8405 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
8406
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008407 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
8408 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8409 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00008410 }
8411 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008412 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
8413 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008414 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008415 return UnOp;
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00008416
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008417 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008418 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008419 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008420 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008421 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008422
8423 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008424 // FIXME: avoid copy.
8425 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008426 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008427 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8428 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008429 }
8430
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008431 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
8432 ULE->getQualifier(),
8433 ULE->getQualifierRange(),
8434 Fn,
8435 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008436 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008437 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008438 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008439 }
8440
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008441 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008442 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008443 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
8444 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8445 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8446 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
8447 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008448
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008449 Expr *Base;
8450
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008451 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
8452 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008453 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
8454 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
8455 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
8456 MemExpr->getQualifier(),
8457 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(),
8458 Fn,
8459 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
8460 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008461 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008462 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00008463 } else {
8464 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
8465 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
8466 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierRange().getBegin();
8467 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
8468 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
8469 /*isImplicit=*/true);
8470 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008471 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008472 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008473
8474 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008475 MemExpr->isArrow(),
8476 MemExpr->getQualifier(),
8477 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(),
8478 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008479 Found,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008480 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008481 TemplateArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008482 Fn->getType(),
8483 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()
8484 ? VK_LValue : VK_RValue,
8485 OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008486 }
8487
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008488 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
8489 return E;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008490}
8491
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008492ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
8493 DeclAccessPair Found,
8494 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008495 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00008496}
8497
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008498} // end namespace clang